You are on page 1of 324

The Lighting Handbook

Your concise reference book always ready to hand.

Chapter 1

Lighting technology and lighting application


Chapter 2

Standard values for indoor and outdoor lighting


Based on the new European standards Chapter 3

Products
Chapter 4

Lamps and ballasts


Chapter 5

Lighting and room management


Chapter 6

Quickplan calculating the n of lum. required


Chapter 7

Technical information
Chapter 8

Checklists
Chapter 9

Services
Chapter 10

Notes

Imprint: For questions and suggestions on the The Lighting Handbook: Zumtobel Lighting GmbH Schweizer Strasse 30 Postfach 72 6851 Dornbirn, AUSTRIA T +43/(0)5572/390-0 F +43/(0)5572/22 826

2nd edition, revised and updated, December 2008

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 1

Lighting technology and lighting application


What is light? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic parameters used in lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Luminous flux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Luminous intensity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Illuminance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Luminance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traditional quality characteristics of lighting . . . . . . . . The right light traditional and new quality criteria . Illuminance definition of terminology . . . . . . . . . . Glare glare limitation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Light colour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Colour rendition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Measuring illuminance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lighting technology. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Types of lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lighting concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Humanergy Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Comprehensive assessment of lighting quality (ELI) . . . Visual performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vista . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visual comfort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vitality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Empowerment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Calculation of energy efficiency (LENI) . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 45 4 5 5 5 68 6 67 7 8 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 16 18 17 17 17 18 18 19

What is light?
Light is that part of the electromagnetic spectrum that is perceived by our eyes.

What is light? Wavelength [m] 10-10 Gamma rays X-rays Ultraviolet Visible light 10
-5

What does the human eye see? Relative spectral brightness perception 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 Infrared Microwaves 0.2 350 450 550 650 750 Wavelength [nm] Wavelength [m] Night Day

100

Television, VSW Medium wave

105

Radio waves

By day we see in colour, while at night we can only see in shades of grey.

The Lighting Handbook

Light has a triple effect: Light for visual functions llumination of task area in conformity with relevant standards glare-free and convenient Light creating biological effects Supporting peoples biological rhythms Stimulating and motivating Light for emotional perception Pleasant lighting enhancing the interior design Makes people relax and feel at ease

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 1 / 3

Basic parameters used in lighting


Luminous flux Luminous intensity Illuminance Luminance

Luminous ux

I=

E=

Lumen [lm] Luminous intensity I Illuminance E

Candela [lm/sr]=[cd] Luminance L L=

Lux [lm/m2]=[lx]

L=

[lm/(sr*m2)]=[cd/m2]

solid angle into which luminous ux is emitted area hit by luminous ux visible areas of light source reectance of area 3.14 for diffuse surface areas

Abbreviation: Unit:

lm

Phi Lumen

4 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Luminous flux The luminous flux describes the quantity of light emitted by a light source. The luminous efficiency is the ratio of the luminous flux to the electrical power consumed (lm/W). It is a measure of a lamps economic efficiency.

Luminous intensity The luminous intensity describes the quantity of light that is radiated in a particular direction. This is a useful measurement for directive lighting elements such as reflectors. It is represented by the luminous intensity distribution curve (LDC).

Abbreviation: Unit:

cd

Candela

Illuminance Illuminance describes the quantity of luminous flux falling on a surface. It decreases by the square of the distance (inverse square law). Relevant standards specify the required illuminance (e.g. EN 12464 Lighting of indoor workplaces). Illuminance: E(lx) = luminous flux (lm) area (m2)

Abbreviation: Unit:

E lx

Lux

Luminance Luminance is the only basic lighting parameter that is perceived by the eye. It specifies the brightness of a surface and is essentially dependent on its reflectance (finish and colour).
The Lighting Handbook

Abbreviation: Unit:

L cd/m2

Chapter 1 / 5

Traditional quality characteristics of lighting


The right light traditional and new quality criteria
T R A D I T I O N A L

Harmonious brightness distribution Sufficient illumination level

Glare limitation Avoidance of reflections

Good modelling Correct light colour Appropriate colour rendition

Quality criteria
Changing lighting situations Personal control Energy efficiency Daylight integration Light as an interior design element

N E W

Illuminance definition of terminology Each term corresponds to the new European standards (see Chapter 2 / 2). Illuminance maintenance value Em: value that the illuminance level must not fall below in the visual task area. Visual task area: illuminance levels are specified for specific visual tasks and are designed for the area in which these may take place. If the precise location is not known, then the whole room or a specific working area is used to define it. The visual task area may be a horizontal, vertical or inclined plane. Area immediately surrounding the visual task area: here illuminance may be one level lower than in the visual task area (e.g. 300 lx to 500 lx). Maintenance factor: the initial value multiplied by the maintenance factor gives the illuminance maintenance value. The maintenance factor accounts for the reduction in luminous flux from lamps, luminaires and room surfaces in the installation, and can be determined on a case-by-case basis. The maintenance schedule (the cleaning and maintenance intervals for the lamps and installation) must be documented. See also Chapter 8 / 22 on Economic efficiency calculation.

6 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Relative illuminance (%)


150 125 100 75 50 25 maintenance value initial value

operating time
Maintenance value = maintenance factor x initial value Glare glare limitation Direct glare Reflected glare

luminaires without glare control very bright surfaces loss of concentration more frequent mistakes fatigue
The Lighting Handbook

reflective surfaces incorrect luminaire arrangement incorrect workstation position loss of concentration more frequent mistakes fatigue matching luminaire to workstation (layout) indirect lighting matt surfaces

remedy

luminaires with limited luminance levels blinds

effect

cause

Chapter 1 / 7

Light colour The light colour describes the colour appearance of the light.
Colour temperature Appearance ww nw tw up to 3,300 K 3,300 K 5,300 K above 5,300 K reddish white blue-ish Association warm intermediate cool

Ww = warm white, nw = intermediate, tw = cool white

The light colour sets the underlying mood of the room! Colour rendition
Colour rendition index Ra 90 8089 7079 6069 4059 2039 Daylight Incandescent lamp Compact fluorescent lamp Fluorescent lamp Mercury vapour highpressure lamp Metal halide lamp Sodium vapour highpressure lamp

Application examples (minimum requirements for Ra): Ra 90: colour inspection Ra 80 89: offices Ra 70 79: electronics industry Ra 60 69: assembly work Ra 40 59: fabrication shop Ra 20 39: warehouses

Display format on fluorescent lamps Example 840: 8 Ra 80 Colour temperature 4,000 K (nw)
The Lighting Handbook

40

8 / Chapter 1

Measuring illuminance
Mean illuminance is the arithmetic mean of the point brilliance levels measured with a luxmeter in a defined grid, under precisely specified conditions. Measuring instruments: description and precision L: maximum precision, tolerance 3% A: high precision, tolerance 5% B: average precision; tolerance 10% (minimum requirement) Measuring conditions avoid external light/daylight (measure separately and subtract) check mains voltage and ambient temperature use new, burnt-in lamps (discharge lamps 100 h) Measuring grid and measuring level workplaces = 0.75 m; sports facilities (floor) = 0.03 m circulation areas, stairs, car parks (floor) = 0.03 m cylindrical illuminance = 1.2 m measuring grid: congruent triangles; approx. 1 m distance measuring grid not congruent with arrangement grid
Size of measuring field 1m 5m 10 m 50 m 100 m Grid element spacing 0.2 m 0.5 m 1.0 m 3.0 m 5.0 m

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 1 / 9

Lighting technology
Under the new European standard for interior workplace lighting, EN 12464, (psychological) glare is assessed by the unified glare rating method (UGR), which is based on a formula for glare. It takes account of all the luminaires in a system contributing to the sensation of glare. UGR tables derived from this formula are provided by the manufacturers for glare rating. The Quickplan tables in Chapter 6 and the lighting catalogues contain reference values for specific room sizes. UGR = 8 log 0.25 Lb (1)

L2 P2 (2)

The UGR method takes account of all the luminaires in the system that contribute to the glare sensation (2) as well as the brightness of walls and ceilings (1). It produces a UGR index. The two methods the one set out in DIN 5035 and the one defined in EN 12464 produce comparable results. UGR limits (UGRL), that must not be exceeded: 16 19 22 25 28 Technical drawing Reading, writing, training, meetings, computer-based work Craft and light industries Heavy industry Railway platforms, foyers

10 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Quality class for nominal illuminance (lx) 1000 750 500 <300 A 1 2000 1500 1000 750 500 <300 2 2000 1000 500 <300 3 2000 1000 500 <300

25

28

22

8 6 4 3

a hs
1 55

13

UGRL

85

75

65

= 45

The Lighting Handbook

The previously used luminance limiting curve method defined in DIN 5035 assesses the mean luminance of the luminaires across a beam angle of 45 to 85. The new European standard sets UGR = 19 as the maximum permissible value for offices, which is equivalent to the luminance limiting curve for 500 lx in Quality class 1. Chapter 1 / 11

= 85

45

8 103

3 4 5 6 8 104 2 Luminance L in cd/m2

16

19

3 4

Types of lighting

Direct lighting: highly directional strong glare reduction at certain angles dark ceiling (cave effect) limited flexibility of workstation layout energy-efficient

Indirect lighting: diffuse lighting conditions room gains in height glare-free workstations can be positioned anywhere low energy efficiency

12 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Indirect/direct lighting: pleasant room impression high user acceptance good contrast ratios flexible workstation layout (indirect component > 60 %)

Mellow Light: indirect/direct solution for low ceiling heights workstations can be positioned anywhere glare-free reduced luminance levels at all viewing angles gives impression of daylight in room

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 1 / 13

Lighting concepts
The definition of individual visual tasks for the purpose of lighting design in a room, as provided for in the EN 12464 standard, opens up new perspectives for lighting design. The quantity and quality of light can now be specified exactly for any task area (see Chapter 2 / 2). TASK AREA lighting concepts are a customised tool to fully exploit the additional options provided. At the same time they offer financial scope that can be used to improve lighting comfort and enhance the room effect.

Visual function TASK AREA lighting concepts provide the right quantity of light of the best possible quality for every visual task. Uniformity, control of glare and reflections, good contrast rendition and shadow detail are consistently matched to the respective task. The lighting is not based on the room but perfectly adjusted to peoples needs. Emotional and biological effects Focusing the lighting onto clearly defined areas means saving investment and operating costs. The funds saved can be used to improve comfort and enhance the room atmosphere, for instance by exciting lighting accents, illuminated walls or dynamic lighting scenarios. Optimum energy efficiency Large buildings provide huge potential for optimisation of energy consumption. Lighting that is consistently focussed onto individual task areas reduces mean illuminance levels and therefore the average expenditure on energy. Savings can be further increased by using daylight-based lighting management and presence detectors.

14 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Room-related lighting concepts take neither individual task areas nor different visual tasks into account. They are based on the most demanding task performed in the room. The position of the workstation is not defined, the entire room disposes of a uniform lighting quality.

The Lighting Handbook

Lighting focussed onto individual visual task areas provides for varied light design in the room. By illuminating walls, for instance, rooms can be designed to be much more open and attractive; dynamic lighting situations can enhance their visual quality.

Chapter 1 / 15

Humanergy Balance
Human aspects + energy efficiency = Humanergy Balance The Humanergy Balance concept harmonises both aspects of lighting and makes it possible to assess them: ELI, the lighting quality indicator, takes their physical and psychological effects on people into account; LENI, the energy efficiency indicator, assesses the economic and ecological aspects of light.

Comprehensive assessment of lighting quality (ELI)


The Ergonomic Lighting Indicator (ELI) allows to assess lighting quality in terms of quantity, using five descriptive quality criteria. Checklists are used to record the individual criteria, which are displayed in a Kiviat graph (spider chart). The outermost line in the graph indicates optimum fulfilment of a criterion.

Visual performance

E
Empowerment

B
Vista

D
Vitality

C
Visual comfort

Example of ELI assessment using a spider chart.

16 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Visual performance Lighting in conformity with relevant standards is decisive for ensuring that a visual task can be identified and the related activities can be carried out. Consideration of the traditional quality characteristics of lighting has a major impact on visual task performance. Lighting level Uniformity of illuminance Colour rendition Avoiding hard shadows Contrast rendition Physiological glare Vista In prestigious buildings, for example, light is not only needed for seeing but also enhances the looks of the interior. Light can provide guidance and make people accept the interior on account of the first visual impression they get. Architectural design Mental design Guidance Hierarchy of perception External appearance Material Luminaires protection type Protection against harmful radiation Visual comfort Light is not only needed in the visual task area, but also for perception in the room. Rooms should be illuminated with uniform brightness and lighting balance. Balanced brightness distribution Varying luminance levels Plasticity/modelling Discomfort glare Uniform illuminance in area around visual task Sense of security Artificial light complemented by daylight Use of flicker-free ballasts

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 1 / 17

Vitality Light significantly influences peoples activity and sense of wellbeing. Moreover, it has a positive impact on their health and may even enhance or influence biological processes. Sense of well-being Activation and stimulation Circadian rhythm Lighting similar to daylight Avoiding danger spots Avoiding thermal radiation Electromagnetic fields Empowerment Varying visual requirements, visual tasks or periods of use call for options to individually influence ones lighting situation. Sensors and control systems help users adjust the lighting situation to their personal needs. Individual influence by switching and dimming Choice of lighting scene Presence detection Daylight-based control Choice of lighting scenarios Flexibility for layout changes Privacy Use of the charts is described in Chapter 8 / 310 Checklists.

18 / Chapter 1

The Lighting Handbook

Calculation of energy efficiency (LENI)


The Lighting Energy Numeric Indicator (LENI) stands for a lighting installations actual energy consumption in kWh per square metre and year. LENI is calculated according to the normative specifications of the EN 15193 standard. Formula for calculating a lighting installations energy consumption:

{ (Pn x FC) x {(tD x FO x FD) + (tN x FO)} kWh/(year x m2) A Without elaborating on individual parameters in greater detail, the following relevant factors are identified: LENI =
the installed load (Pn) multiplied by the annual hours of use by day (tD) and at night (tN) reduced by factors ( 1) for daylight-based control (FD), presence-based control (FO) and use of a lighting control system (FC) the area assessed (A) LENI also takes charging energy for emergency lighting and standby energy into account. The following factors have a positive impact on the reduction of energy consumption: Sensible control of lighting Use of daylight Use of presence detectors Intelligent consideration of hours of use Energy-efficient lamps Need-based use of luminaires and lighting solutions, specified for the respective application Constant lighting control (maintenance control)

60
The Lighting Handbook

120

0
Energy consumption in kWh/(m2 year)

180

Chapter 1 / 19

Chapter 2

Standard values for indoor and outdoor lighting


Standard values for lighting of indoor and outdoor workplaces and sports facility lighting . . . . . . . Indoor workplaces. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traffic zones and general areas inside buildings . . . . Industrial activities and crafts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Retail premises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Places of public assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Educational premises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Health care premises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transportational areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sports facilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outdoor workplaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General circulation areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Airports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building sites. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel filling service stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Industrial sites and storage areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parking areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Petrochemical and other hazardous industries. . . . . . Power, electricity, gas and heat plants . . . . . . . . . . . Railway and tramways . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Saw mills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

2 3 12 3 37 7 8 8 89 9 10 11 11 12 13 15 13 13 13 13 13 14 14 14 14 15 15

Standard values for lighting of indoor and outdoor workplaces and sports facility lighting
Em gives the illuminance maintenance values specified in the European standards which partially or completely replace national standards (e.g. DIN 5035, Austrian standard O 1040, Swiss lighting standard SLG 8912, DIN 67526). Lighting of indoor workplaces, EN 12464-1 (April 2003) Lighting of outdoorwork places, EN 12464-2 (October 2007) Sports facility lighting, EN 12193 (April 2008) (see also Definition of terminology, Chapter 1 / 6) Illuminance levels must not fall below the Em maintenance values in the visual task area. If the precise location is not known, the limit should be applied to the whole room or a specific working area. Example for an office task area:
task
height = 0.75 m

area

use

r flo

or-a

rea

1.00 m The maintenance factors can be determined on a case-by-case basis from the manufacturers data (see also Chapter 8). The maintenance factors and schedules for Zumtobel luminaires are given in the Quickplan tables (Chapter 6).

Where no individual maintenance data is available, the following values are recommended as reference maintenance factors for modern technology and three-yearly maintenance: 0.67 in a clean atmosphere, and 0.50 in very dirty environments. EN 12464 specifies that the lighting designer must document the maintenance factor and maintenance schedule. UGRL is the upper limit for direct glare. The UGR value calculated in the design process must lie below this (the Quickplan tables give the UGR figure for the luminaire used in a medium-size reference room). Ra is the lower limit for the colour rendition index. The Ra of the selected lamp must be equal to or greater than this value.

The Lighting Handbook

Type of interior, task or activity

Em

UGRL

Ra

Traffic zones and general areas inside buildings


Traffic zones Circulation areas and corridors Stairs, escalators, travolators Loading ramps/bays Rest, sanitation and first aid rooms Canteens, pantries Rest rooms Rooms for physical exercise Cloakrooms, washrooms, bathrooms, toilets Sick bay Rooms for medical attention Control rooms Plant rooms, switch gear rooms Telex, post room, switchboard Store rooms, cold stores Store and stockrooms Dispatch packing handling areas Storage rack areas Gangways: unmanned Gangways: manned Control stations 100 150 150 200 100 300 200 500 500 200 500 100 300 20 150 150 28 25 25 22 22 22 25 19 16 25 19 25 25 22 22 40 40 40 80 80 80 80 80 90 60 80 60 60 40 60 60

Industrial activities and crafts


Agriculture Loading and operating of goods, handling equipment and machinery Buildings for livestock Sick animal pens; calving stalls Feed preparation; dairy; utensil washing Bakeries Preparation and baking Finishing, glazing, decorating Cement, cement goods, concrete, bricks Drying Preparation of materials; work on kilns and mixers General machine work Rough forms Ceramics, tiles, glass, glassware Drying Preparation, general machine work Enamelling, rolling, pressing, shaping simple parts, glazing, glass blowing Grinding, engraving, glass polishing, shaping precision parts, manufacture of glass instruments 200 50 200 200 300 500 50 200 300 300 50 300 300 750 25 25 25 22 22 28 28 25 25 28 25 25 19 80 40 80 80 80 80 20 40 80 80 20 80 80 80

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 2 / 3

Type of interior, task or activity Grinding of optical glass, crystal, hand grinding and engraving Precision work e.g. decorative grinding, hand painting Manufacture of synthetic precious stones Chemical, plastics and rubber industry Remote-operated processing installations Processing installations with limited manual intervention Constantly manned work places in processing installations Precision measuring rooms, laboratories Pharmaceutical production Tyre production Colour inspection Cutting, finishing, inspection Electrical industry Cable and wire manufacture Winding: large coils medium-sized coils small coils Coil impregnating Galvanising Assembly work: rough e.g. large transformers medium e.g. switchboards fine e.g. telephones precision e.g. measuring equipment Electronic workshops, testing, adjusting Food stuffs and luxury food industry Work places and zones in breweries, malting floor for washing, barrel filling, cleaning, sieving, peeling cooking in preserve and chocolate factories work places and zones in sugar factories for drying and fermenting raw tobacco, fermentation cellar Sorting and washing of products, milling, mixing, packing Work places and critical zones in slaughter houses, butchers, dairies mills, on filtering floor in sugar refineries Cutting and sorting of fruit and vegetables Manufacture of delicatessen foods, kitchen work, manufacture of cigars and cigarettes

Em

UGRL

Ra

750 1000 1500 50 150 300 500 500 500 1000 750 300 300 500 750 300 300 300 500 750 1000 1500

16 16 16 28 25 19 22 22 16 19 25 25 22 19 25 25 25 22 19 16 16

80 90 90 20 40 80 80 80 80 90 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

200 300 500 300 500

25 25 25 25 22

80 80 80 80 80

4 / Chapter 2

The Lighting Handbook

Type of interior, task or activity Inspection of glasses and bottles, product control, trimming, sorting, decoration Laboratories Colour inspection Foundries and metal casting Man-size underfloor tunnels, cellars, etc. Platforms Sand preparation Dressing room Work places at cupola and mixer Casting bay Shake out areas Machine moulding Hand and core moulding Die casting Model building Hairdressers Hairdressing Jewellery manufacturing Working with precious stones Manufacture of jewellery Watch making (manual) Watch making (automatic) Laundries and dry cleaning Goods in, marking and sorting Washing and dry cleaning Ironing, pressing Inspection and repairs Leather and leather goods Work on vats, barrels, pits Fleshing, skiving, rubbing, tumbling of skins Saddlery work, shoe manufacture: stitching, sewing, polishing, shaping, cutting, punching Sorting Leather dyeing (machine) Quality control Colour inspection Shoe making Glove making Metal working and processing Open die forging Drop forging Welding Rough and average machining: tolerances 0.1 mm Precision machining; grinding: tolerances < 0.1 mm Scribing; inspection

Em

UGRL

Ra

500 500 1000 50 100 200 200 200 200 200 200 300 300 500 500 1500 1000 1500 500 300 300 300 750 200 300 500 500 500 1000 1000 500 500 200 300 300 300 500 750

22 19 16 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 22 19 16 16 16 19 25 25 25 19 25 25 22 22 22 19 16 22 22 25 25 25 22 19 19

80 80 90 20 40 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 90 90 90 80 80 80 80 80 80 40 80 80 90 80 80 90 80 80 60 60 60 60 60 60

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 2 / 5

Type of interior, task or activity

Em

UGRL 25 25 22 19 25 25 22 19 25 25 19 25 25 22 28 25 25 16

Ra 60 60 60 60 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 20 40 80 60 80 20

20

6 / Chapter 2

The Lighting Handbook

Wire and pipe drawing shops; cold forming 300 Plate machining: thickness 5 mm 200 Sheet metalwork: thickness < 5 mm 300 Tool making; cutting equipment manufacture 750 Assembly: rough 200 medium 300 fine 500 precision 750 Galvanising 300 Surface preparation and painting 750 Tool, template and jig making, precision mechanics, micromechanics 1000 Paper and paper goods Edge runners, pulp mills 200 Paper manufacture and processing, paper and corrugating machines, cardboard manufacture 300 Standard bookbinding work, e.g. folding, sorting, gluing, cutting, embossing, sewing 500 Power stations Fuel supply plant 50 Boiler house 100 Machine halls 200 Side rooms, e.g. pump rooms, condenser rooms etc.; switchboards (inside buildings) 200 Control rooms 500 Outdoor switch gear 20 Printers Cutting, gilding, embossing, block engraving, work on stones and platens, printing machines, matrix making 500 Paper sorting and hand printing 500 Type setting, retouching, lithography 1000 Colour inspection in multicoloured printing 1500 Steel and copper engraving 2000 Rolling mills, iron and steel works Production plants without manual operation 50 Production plants with occasional manual operation 150 Production plants with continuous manual operation 200 Slab Store 50 Furnaces 200 Mill train; coiler; shear line 300 Control platforms; control panels 300 Test, measurement and inspection 500 Underfloor man-sized tunnels; belt sections; cellars etc. 50

19 19 19 16 16 28 25 25 25 22 22

80 80 80 90 80 20 40 80 20 20 40 80 80

Type of interior, task or activity

Em

UGRL

Ra

Textile manufacture and processing Work places and zones in baths, bale opening 200 Carding, washing, ironing, devilling machine work, drawing, combing, sizing, card cutting, pre-spinning, jute and hemp spinning 300 Spinning, plying, reeling, winding 500 Warping, weaving, braiding, knitting 500 Sewing, fine knitting, taking up stitches 750 Manual design, drawing patterns 750 Finishing, dyeing 500 Drying room 100 Automatic fabric printing 500 Burling, picking, trimming 1000 Colour inspection; fabric control 1000 Invisible mending 1500 Hat manufacturing 500 Vehicle construction Body work and assembly 500 Painting, spraying chamber, polishing chamber 750 Painting: touch-up, inspection 1000 Upholstery manufacture (manned) 1000 Final inspection 1000 Wood working and processing Automatic processing e.g. drying, plywood manufacturing 50 Steam pits 150 Saw frame 300 Work at joiners bench, gluing, assembly 300 Polishing, painting, fancy joinery 750 Work on wood working machines e.g. turning, fluting, dressing, rebating, grooving, cutting, sawing, sinking 500 Selection of veneer woods 750 Marquetry, inlay work 750 Quality control, inspection 1000

25 22 22 22 22 22 22 28 25 19 16 19 22 22 22 19 19 19

60 80 80 80 80 90 80 60 80 80 90 90 80 80 80 90 80 80

28 28 25 25 22 19 22 22 19

40 40 60 80 80 80 90 90 90

Offices
Offices Filing, copying, etc. Writing, typing, reading, data processing Technical drawing CAD work stations Conference and meeting rooms Reception desk Archives 300 500 750 500 500 300 200 19 19 16 19 19 22 25 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 2 / 7

Type of interior, task or activity

Em

UGRL

Ra

Retail premises
Retail premises Sales area Till area Wrapper table 300 500 500 22 19 19 80 80 80

Places of public assembly


General areas Entrance halls Cloakrooms Lounges Ticket offices Restaurants and hotels Reception/cashier desk, porters desk Kitchen Restaurant, dining room, function room Self-service restaurant Buffet Conference rooms Corridors Theatres, concert halls, cinemas Practice rooms, dressing rooms Trade fairs, exhibition halls General lighting Museums Exhibits, insensitive to light Light sensitive exhibits Libraries Bookshelves Reading area Counters Public car parks (indoor) In/out ramps (during the day) In/out ramps (at night) Traffic lanes Parking areas Ticket office 100 200 200 300 300 500 200 300 500 100 300 300 22 25 22 22 22 22 22 22 19 25 22 22 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

according to requirements 200 500 500 300 75 75 75 300 19 19 19 25 25 25 19 80 80 80 20 20 20 20 80

Educational premises
Nursery school, play school Play room Nursery Handicraft room Educational buildings Classrooms, tutorial rooms Classroom for evening classes and adults education 300 300 300 300 500 19 19 19 19 19 80 80 80 80 80
The Lighting Handbook

8 / Chapter 2

Type of interior, task or activity Lecture hall Black board Demonstration table Art rooms Art rooms in art schools Technical drawing rooms Practical rooms and laboratories Handicraft rooms Teaching workshop Music practice rooms Computer practice rooms (menu driven) Language laboratory Preparation rooms and workshops Entrance halls Circulation areas, corridors Stairs Student common rooms and assembly halls Teachers rooms Library: bookshelves Library: reading areas Stock rooms for teaching materials Sports halls, gymnasiums, swimming pools (general use) School canteens Kitchen

Em 500 500 500 500 750 750 500 500 500 300 300 300 500 200 100 150 200 300 200 500 100 300 200 500

UGRL 19 19 19 19 19 16 19 19 19 19 19 19 22 22 25 25 22 19 19 19 25 22 22 22

Ra 80 80 80 80 90 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

Health care premises


Rooms for general use Waiting rooms Corridors: during the day Corridors: during the night Day rooms Staff rooms Staff office Staff rooms Wards, maternity wards General lighting Reading lighting Simple examinations Examination and treatment Night lighting, observation lighting Bathrooms and toilets for patients Examination rooms (general) General lighting Examination and treatment Eye examination rooms General lighting Examination of the outer eye 200 200 50 200 500 300 100 300 300 1000 5 200 500 1000 300 1000 22 22 22 22 19 19 19 19 19 19 22 19 19 19 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 90 80 80 90 90 80 90

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 2 / 9

Type of interior, task or activity Reading and colour vision tests with vision charts Ear examination rooms General lighting Ear examination Scanner rooms General lighting Scanners with image enhancers and television systems Delivery rooms General lighting Examination and treatment Treatment rooms (general) Dialysis Dermatology Endoscopy rooms Plaster rooms Medical baths Massage and radiotherapy Operating areas Pre-op and recovery rooms Operating theatre Operating cavity Intensive care unit General lighting Simple examinations Examination and treatment Night watch Dentists General lighting At the patient Operating cavity White teeth matching Laboratories and pharmacies General lighting Colour inspection Decontamination rooms Sterilisation rooms Disinfection rooms Autopsy rooms and mortuaries General lighting Autopsy table and dissecting table

Em

UGRL

Ra

500 300 1000 300 50 300 1000 500 500 300 500 300 300 500 1000

16 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19

90 80 90 80 80 80 80 80 90 80 80 80 80 90 90

100 300 1000 20 500 1000 5000 5000 500 1000 300 300 500 5000

19 19 19 19 19 19 19 22 22 19

90 90 90 90 90 90 90 90 80 90 80 80 90 90
The Lighting Handbook

10 / Chapter 2

Type of interior, task or activity

Em

UGRL

Ra

Transportational areas
Airports Arrival and departure halls, baggage claim areas Connecting areas, escalators, travolators Information desks, check-in desks Customs and passport control desks Waiting areas Luggage store rooms Security check areas Air traffic control tower Testing and repair hangars Engine test areas Measuring areas in hangars Railway installations Covered platforms and passenger subways (underpasses) Ticket hall and concourse Ticket and luggage offices and counters Waiting rooms 200 150 500 500 200 200 300 500 500 500 500 22 22 19 19 22 25 19 16 22 22 22 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

50 200 300 200

28 28 19 22

40 40 80 80

Sports facilities
The following details apply to competition class I (lower requirements apply to classes II and III) Em and Ra data according to European Standard EN 12193 General school sports data from EN 12464 An Ra level of 80 should be preferred For lighting for training purposes, usually an UGRL level of 22 should be observed Aerobics 500 Archery 200 Athletics (all disciplines) 500 Badminton 750 Basketball 750 Billards 750 Boccia 300 Boules 300 Bowling 200 Bowls 500 Boxing (competition/training) 2000/300 Climbing 500 Cricket 750 Cricket nets 1500 Curling (target/playing area) 300/200 Cycling 750 Dancing (fitness) 500 Darts 200

The Lighting Handbook

60 60 60 60 60 80 60 60 60 60 80 60 60 60 60 60 60 60

Chapter 2 / 11

Type of interior, task or activity Fencing Football (indoor) Gymnastics Handball Hockey Ice hockey Ice skating Judo Kendo/Karate Netball Petanque Racketball Riding Roller skating School sports Shooting Snooker Speed skating Squash Swimming Swimmung (school level) Table tennis Tennis Volleyball Weight lifting Wrestling

Em 750 750 500 750 750 750 750 750 750 750 300 750 500 500 750 200 750 500 750 300 500 750 750 750 750 750

Ra 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 80 60 60 80 60 60 60 60 60 60

12 / Chapter 2

The Lighting Handbook

Type of area, task or activity

Em

UGRL

Ra

General circulation areas at outdoor workplaces


Walkways exclusively for pedestrians Traffic areas for slowly moving vehicles max. (10 km/h), e.g. bicycles, trucks and excavators Regular vehicle traffic (max. 40 km/h) Pedestrian passages, vehicle turning, loading and unloading points 5 10 20 50 20 30 50 50 200 20 50 100 200 5 20 50 150 150 20 20 20 20 20 40 40 40 60 20 20 40 40 20 20 20 20 20

Airports
Hangar apron Terminal apron Loading areas Fuel depot Aircraft maintenance stands

Building sites
Clearance, excavation and loading Construction areas, drain pipes mounting, transport, auxiliary and storage tasks Framework element mounting, light reinforcement work, wooden mould and framework mounting, electric piping and cabling Element jointing, demanding electrical, machine and pipe mountings

Fuel filling stations


Vehicle parking and storage areas Entry and exit driveways: dark environment (i.e. rural areas and suburbs) Entry and exit driveways: light environment (i.e. cities) Air pressure and water checking points and other service areas Meter reading area

Industrial sites and storage areas


Short term handling of large units and raw materials, loading and unloading of solid bulk goods Continuous handling of large units and raw materials, loading and unloading of freight, lifting and descending location for cranes, open loading platforms Reading of addresses, covered loading platforms, use of tools, ordinary reinforcement and casting tasks in concrete plants Demanding electrical, machine and piping installations, inspection 20 50 100 200 20 20 20 60

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 2 / 13

Type of area, task or activity

Em

Ra

Parking areas
Light traffic, e.g. parking areas of shops, terraced and apartment houses; cycle parks Medium traffic, e.g. parking areas of department stores, office buildings, plants, sports and multipurpose building complexes Heavy traffic, e.g. parking areas of schools, churches, major shopping centres, major sports and multipurpose building complexes 5 10 50 20 20 20

Petrochemical and other hazardous industries


Handling of servicing tools, utilisation of manually regulated valves, starting and stopping motors, lighting of burners Filling and emptying of container trucks and wagons with risk free substances, inspection of leakage, piping and packing Filling and emptying of container trucks and wagons with dangerous substances, replacements of pump packing, general service work, reading of instruments Fuel loading and unloading sites Repair of machines and electric devices 20 50 100 100 200 5 20 50 100 100 200 20 20 40 20 60 20 20 20 40 40 60

Power, electricity, gas and heat plants


Pedestrian movements within electrically safe areas Handling of servicing tools, coal Overall inspection General servicing work and reading of instruments Wind tunnels: servicing and maintenance Repair of electric devices

Railways and tramways


Railway areas including light railways, tramways, monorails, miniature rails, metro, etc. Tracks in passenger station areas, including stabling 10 Railway yards: flat marshalling, retarder and classification yards 10 Hump areas 10 Freight track, short duration operations 10 Open platforms, rural and local trains, small number of passengers 15 Walkways 20 Level crossings 20 Open platforms, suburban and regional trains with large number of passengers or inter-city services with small number of passengers 20 Freight track, continuous operation 20 Open platforms in freight areas 20 Servicing trains and locomotives 20 Railway yards handling areas 30 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 40 20

14 / Chapter 2

The Lighting Handbook

Type of area, task or activity Coupling area Stairs, small and medium-size stations Open platforms, inter-city services Covered platforms, suburban or regional trains or inter-city services with small number of passengers Covered platforms in freight areas, short duration operations Covered platforms, inter-city services Stairs, large stations Covered platforms in freight areas, continuous operation Inspection pit

Em 30 50 50 50 50 100 100 100 100

Ra 20 40 20 40 20 40 40 40 40

Saw mills
Timber handling on land and in water, sawdust and chip conveyors Sorting of timber on land or in water, timber unloading points and sawn timber loading points, mechanical lifting to timber conveyor, stacking Reading of addresses and markings of sawn timber Grading and packaging Feeding into stripping and chopping machines 20 50 100 200 300 20 20 40 40 40

Extracts from Austrian Standard (NORM) EN 12464-1 Light and lighting lighting of workplaces Part 1: indoor workplaces (2003-04-01) Austrian Standard (NORM) EN 12464-2 Light and lighting lighting of workplaces Part 2: outdoor workplaces (2007-10-01) Austrian Standard (NORM EN 12193) Light and lighting sports facility lighting (2008-04-01)
The Lighting Handbook

published with permission by the Austrian Standards Institute, A-1020 Vienna, Heinestrasse 38 Ordering of standards and products, as well as research on the subject at www.on-norm.at

Chapter 2 / 15

Chapter 3

Products (selection)
ZUMTOBEL applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Spots and tracks (SOLAR II, VIVO; VIVO-S + VIVO-SL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHTTOOLS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CARDAN-SPIRIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . STARFLEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2LIGHT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS L and H. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS M/MWW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS S and Q . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PASO II. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VAERO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHT FIELDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MELLOW LIGHT IV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CIELOS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RTX II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIRAL T16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FREELINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Free-standing uplights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED luminaires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SYSTEMLED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ORILED. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HELISSA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SOLINA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PERLUCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCUBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLEAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ZBOX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ONLITE/ONLITE RESCLITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BELIA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TETTOIA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 69 10 11 12 13 14 17 18 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 85 86 87 88 89

Areas of application
Throughout the world, ZUMTOBEL is the competent reliable partner for innovative lighting solutions in all areas of application of professional interior lighting providing global competence, superior product quality and futureproof technologies.

Industry and Engineering In production, the greatest demands are placed on the flexibility, functionality and building management system of industrial buildings. The right light in manufacturing and assembly bays as well as warehouses and workshops is the basis for any productive work. Offices and Communication Spatial structures and lighting systems must be adapted to new types of work. What is required are flexible people, flexible architecture and flexible light which enhances communication and motivation and improves the quality of working and spending time at the office. Education and Science Using light to enhance communication, improve awareness and create social understanding: dynamic lighting solutions with optimum colour properties enhance peoples concentration and improve visual comfort in educational facilities. www.zumtobel.com/applications Chapter 3 / 3

The Lighting Handbook

Presentation and Retail Modern retail worlds must provide a quality of experience, their design becomes an expression of the brand message. Customised lighting solutions are an essential element of these worlds of experience. Hotel and Wellness Those who collect stars for their restaurant or hotel should not only work on their recipes. The guests pleasure starts with the lighting that stimulates all senses. Art and Culture Where the highest architectural requirements must be met, ever greater demands are also made on the element without which room impression and artistic delight are inconceivable: light as a modulating, accentuating factor of experience. Health and Care Light increases the patients sense of wellbeing, creates a living-room ambience, supports the accomplishment of visual tasks in different therapies and examination procedures, makes orientation easier and ensures safety in circulation areas in hospitals, sanatoriums and retirement homes. 4 / Chapter 3 www.zumtobel.com/applications

The Lighting Handbook

Sport and Leisure For each type of sport, special requirements must be met in terms of lighting. Optimum lighting has to ensure the safety of athletes and the best possible viewing conditions for those performing, the audience and the referees. Transit Areas and Parking Light is ideal to bring a more pleasant touch to utility buildings. Leaving ones car in a safely lit car park not only ensures that the paintwork will not be scratched but also that the driver will have a good feeling. Orientation and Safety Lighting provides safety and ensures (self-)reliability: escape sign luminaires in a sophisticated design, and emergency lighting systems as an integral concept including the lighting management and service systems.

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/applications

Chapter 3 / 5

Spots and tracks An unbeatable team

3-phase track high professionalism due to variety of switching options broad range of connectors for any type of track configuration track can be easily installed on ceiling or wall; suspension from cord or pendant tube tracks can be bent to specific radii; exception: tracks with supporting section acceptable: tracks used within manual reach

DALI track 3-phase track with built-in control lines for tapping DALI control signals spotlights with DALI control gear can be individually dimmed and switched at zero power, independent of power supply for each track, up to 64 DALI spots can be separately controlled impressive, dynamic shows and lighting sequences can be run in combination with the EMOTION touch panel by ZUMTOBEL

6 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

In lighting technology, tracks and continuous row lighting systems are vital components providing the basis for active light design. Using DALI, impressive lighting scenarios can be created. A fascinating

interplay of dramatic brightness variations can be staged, while spotlights fitted with colour filters allow to set the stage for pleasant choreographies of coloured light.

SOLAR II New generation flowing lines, organic design


Application: A generation of expressive spotlights with soft and flowing lines for accent and display lighting in shops & display windows galleries & showrooms private settings Design by Massimo Iosa Ghini Models: Spotlight system in two design sizes, in die-cast aluminium, titanium or white, fitted with electronic control gear only for use with state-of-the-art lamp technology: Pros: universal 3-phase adapter by ZUMTOBEL new generation of reflectors with four different beam angles, designed as interchangeable reflectors Benefits: safe, convenient operation thanks to ZUMTOBELs new universal 3-phase adapter can be quickly adjusted to changing lighting tasks using a wide range of interchangeable reflectors

low-voltage halogen incandescent lamps up to 100 W metal halide lamps 20 W to 70 W wide range of accessories that can be combined

organic design AFPS (AirFlow Protection System): increases reliability of electronic ballasts, extends service life of lamps

installation on DALI tracks with DALI transformer, and appropriate DALI adapters for easy integration with digital lighting management systems

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 7

VIVO Lights intuitive freedom of movement


Application: ZUMTOBEL spotlight range for accent and display lighting. A real all-rounder for shops, display windows & retail areas department stores & supermarkets galleries & showrooms private settings Models: Spotlight system in three design sizes, made of diecast aluminium, silver or white, microstructure paint. Fitted with electronic control gear only for use with stateof-the-art lamp technology:

Design by EOOS

low-voltage halogen incandescent lamps up to 100 W metal halide lamps 20 W to 150 W high-pressure sodium discharge lamps up to 100 W wide range of accessories, also for lighting foodstuffs

Pros: interchangeable reflectors integral ball-and-socket joint universal 3-phase adapter by ZUMTOBEL Benefits: can be quickly adjusted to changing lighting tasks using a wide range of interchangeable reflectors safe, convenient operation thanks to ZUMTOBELs new universal 3-phase adapter intuitive, precise adjustment by means of integral clip

track box fitted parallel to track ensures uncluttered look on ceiling

8 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

bayonet joint ensures minimum maintenance of lamps and easy replacement of reflectors and accessories installation on DALI tracks with DALI transformer, and appropriate DALI adapters for easy integration with digital lighting management systems

VIVO-S and VIVO-SL Spotlight system with three hundred and sixty degrees precision
Models: Recessed spotlight; spotlight head pivots from position flush with ceiling to 90 2 design sizes: round and square Pros for VIVO-S: pivots through up to 90 rotates through 360 pivots to position flush with ceiling pivots progressively Squeeze, Move and Retain (SMART) system for intuitive alignment Pros for VIVO-SL: freedom of design, also in case of low-profile ceilings pivots through up to 50 Squeeze, Move and Retain (SMART) system for intuitive alignment HIT G8.5 35/70 W and QT 90 W lamps electronic ballast must be ordered separately

Benefits: complete solution combining ceiling-mounted module and track highly flexible, architecturally consistent lighting concept
The Lighting Handbook

VIVO is a real all-rounder mastering every lighting task in shops and stores

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 9

LIGHTTOOLS Modular lighting system: inconspicuous, easy to install, and versatile


System range: lighting channel, flushmounted, no flange lighting channel, ceiling-bearing, with flange lighting inserts for various spotlight applications lighting inserts for floodlighting and wide-area lighting all lighting inserts can be clicked in and positioned without the use of tools electrical connection via plugin contact (no tools required) Application: shops & display windows foyers & corridor areas showrooms & galleries offices & office areas Benefits: only 100 mm wide, but with HIT up to 70 W installed flush with ceiling (plasterboard ceilings), no flange assembly of lengths on site lighting inserts to be installed and shifted without any tools prepared for operation with DALI (integral bus line) extremely easy design (optional aid: configurator) delivery ex warehouse, no special lengths required Design by Studio Jean-Michel Wilmotte

Material/design: channel sections in aluminium extrusion, U-shape, assembled using 3 sections luminaire housing made of bent sheet steel lighting heads made of diecast aluminium floodlight housing made of extruded aluminium section electronic control gear (optional: DALI gear)

10 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Lamp(s): Spotlight

Floodlight Linear

HIT-TC-CE/up to 70 W Spot & Flood QT-LP 12/90 W Spot & Flood QR-LP 70/50 W HIT-CE G12/70 W HST GX12/100 W T 16 24 up to 54 W, DL & WF

3 pros: Current design reduced to a minimum in material extremely easy planning in advance, as exact definition of lengths not required until on site Easy installation only few components need to be installed no additional connectors required lighting inserts can be fitted without use of tools

building management thanks to DALI integration: integral bus line in channel as standard control gear installed optionally endless cable duct up to 25 m, can be clicked in without use of tools, ensures minimum installation effort

The Lighting Handbook

Versatility suitable for all types of ceilings: without flange for plasterboard ceilings ceiling-bearing (with flange) for all other ceilings various different channel looks: with pivoting lighting heads with flush lighting heads as an open channel (gap between lighting inserts open)

as a closed channel (gaps closed by cover sections)

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 11

CARDAN-SPIRIT Modular lighting system: unobtrusive and flexible


System range: Ceiling-recessed luminaires autonomous design according to the SPIRIT spotlight range fitted with up to 4 x 70 W HIT extremely flat design of model fitted with QR111 wide range of technical lighting accessories easy replacement of reflectors Lighting frame autonomous, unique design high illumination output: up to 4 x 70 W HIT can be fitted with mixed lamps wide range of technical lighting accessories DALI-compatible (inc. RGB colour changes) can be installed in different locations in a room: horizontally suspended vertically suspended installed on wall/ceiling Lighting technology: lighting heads for no-tool reflector replacement silver-colour spot & flood specular reflectors complete range of accessories for the Spirit spotlight range can be used lighting heads pivot on gimbals through approx. 2 x 45 12 / Chapter 3

Application: upmarket shops & shop windows foyers & corridor areas showrooms & galleries entrance & office areas prestigious private settings Design by Studio Jean-Michel Wilmotte

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

in lighting frames in particular: built-in electronic ballasts, separately for each lamp DALI version (transformers & bus feed line) available if required RGB model as stand-alone version also available upon request

Range/lamp(s): Ceiling-recessed luminaires 1-lamp, round 1-lamp to 4-lamp, square QR 111/100 W (also FLAT) QT 12/100 W Spot & Flood HIT-TC-CE 35 + 70 W Spot & Flood separate ballasts (accessories)

Lighting frame 2-lamp to 4-lamp QR 111/100 W FLAT QT 12/100 W Spot & Flood HIT-TC-CE 35 + 70 W Spot & Flood electronic ballasts included

3 Pros: Functionality complete SPIRIT accessories can be fitted accessories replaced from the front (lamps & reflectors & filters) ventilation of lighting head ensures optimum thermal conditions Lighting technology Spirit lighting head as base power packages: up to 4 x 70 W HIT can be fitted with mixed lamps prepared for DALI integration FLAT version for QR 111

Variety of creative design options recessed into ceiling horizontally & vertically suspended installed on wall & underneath the ceiling

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 13

STARFLEX The modular fibre optic system


Fibre optic technology provides fascinating options for precise, impressive display lighting. A broad product range including light engines and optical fibres Models: Engines halogen QR-CBC 50100 W light engines HIT 35250 W light engines HIT 150/250 W light engines, controllable (DALI; 110 V; DMX) Light outlets decorative crystal light heads pivoting surface-mounted and recessed lenses with defined beam angle IP-protected light outlets for outdoor and underwater applications projection heads for extremely narrow-beam lighting as well as slide and gobo projections Optical fibre fibre with terminal light emission (glass; Schott Spectraflex) fibre with terminal light emission (PMMA; Mitsubishi) side-radiating fibre (PMMA, Mitsubishi) Accessories colour and colour temperature correction filters colour and sparkle-effect wheel modules control lines and input units 14 / Chapter 3 www.zumtobel.com/productsites as well as a variety of accessories allow to create customised lighting solutions for numerous applications.

The Lighting Handbook

Benefits: precise direction of light colour temperature can be adjusted to meet special project requirements broad range of light engines from 35 W to 250 W, for indoor and outdoor areas as well as damp areas

separation of light and electricity, UV and IR components projection of logos or slides modular design for customised project solutions

Pros: STARFLEX for presentation and retail maintenance-friendly and UV/IR-free lighting of fashion space-saving (e. g. display items, foodstuffs or cases with alarm system) jewellery/watches can be integrated with light- precise illumination of ing management solutions display windows and showvia control line of bus syscases tem STARFLEX for art and culture conservational lighting without UV and IR components light colour adjusted via corresponding light sources and fibre material

precise narrow-beam illumination with sharp outlines via appropriate outlets

STARFLEX for wellness and fitness areas underwater lighting in swim- lighting of applications proming pools, wells and ponds viding accents (water film on stainless steel sheets, etc.) STARFLEX projection Projection e. g.: at the cinema, for product advertising or visitor information in shops, museums and galleries based on fibre optics

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 15

Properties and applications of optical fibres Fibre Properties material Glass can withstand relatively high temperatures (up to 110 C) extremely long service life (in excess of 20 years) relatively tight bending radius projects preferring relatively warm light colour PMMA cheaper than glass life time in excess of 20 years projects involving relatively cool light colour choice of side-radiating or terminal light emitting fibres side-radiating and terminal light-emitting fibres can be combined in a single fibre bundle fibre bundle can optionally be assembled on site Assembly of glass fibre bundles Active diameter of fibre cable 1.0 mm 1.5 mm 2.0 mm 3.0 mm 4.5 mm 6.0 mm Outer diameter Maximum number of sheathing of individual fibres per common end spigot 2.2 mm 615 2.7 mm 307 3.9 mm 176 4.9 mm 79 6.4 mm 36 8.7 mm 20 Minimum bending radius 7 mm 11 mm 14 mm 21 mm 32 mm 42 mm Applications glass display cases in museums saunas and steam baths hotel and restaurant lighting

applications requiring high levels of illumination retail shop windows, display shelving and show cases starry skies in hotels and wellness areas outdoor lighting or in areas with high air humidity

1m 2m 3m

4m

5m 6m

7m 8m

9 m 10 m

0.93 0.87 0.81 0.76 0.71 0.66 0.62 0.57 0.54 0.50

16 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Length-based correction factors (attenuation) for glass fibre cables

Assembly of PMMA fibre bundles (terminal light emission, factory-assembled) Active diameter of fibre cable Outer diameter Maximum number of sheathing of individual fibres per common end spigot crimped/ spliced 2.2 mm 575/300 2.7 mm 342/165 4.0 mm 143/70 5.0 mm 72/35 6.5 mm 37/18 8.5 mm 20/10 10.5 mm 13/6 12.0 mm 8/4 Minimum bending radius

1.0 mm 1.5 mm 2.0 mm 3.0 mm 4.5 mm 6.0 mm 8.0 mm 10.0 mm

8 mm 12 mm 16 mm 24 mm 36 mm 48 mm 60 mm 75 mm

Length-based correction factors (attenuation) for PMMA cables


1m 2m 3m 4m 5m 6m 7m 8m 9 m 10 m

0.95 0.91 0.87 0.83 0.79 0.75 0.72 0.69 0.65 0.62

Assembly of PMMA fibre bundles (side radiation, factory-assembled) Outer diameter Maximum number of of sheathing individual fibres per common end spigot (crimped) 4.5 mm 80 8.0 mm 19 11.0 mm 11 14.0 mm 6 Maximum number of individual fibres per common end spigot (spliced) 40 10 5 3

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 17

2LIGHT High-quality downlight system


2LIGHT MINI unique, high-quality MINIATURE downlight system for accent lighting Application: display lighting, restaurants, cafeterias, bars, reception areas, hotels, residential properties

2LIGHT-C MINI (CARDAN) unique, high-quality MINIATURE downlight system for accent lighting maximum application flexibility thanks to integral pivoting lamp units

Application: sales counters, small presentation areas, points of sale, shelf lighting

2LIGHT MINI, surfacemounted unique, high-quality MINIATURE downlight system for accent lighting surface-mounted housing can be installed quickly using CLIX mechanism

Application: display lighting, reception areas, corridors, foyers and all other applications for which surface-mounted luminaires can be used

2LIGHT unique, high-quality downlight system for wide-area general lighting

Application: reception areas, waiting areas, restaurants, corridors, foyers, conference rooms, relaxation areas, shopping arcades

18 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

2LIGHT-C (CARDAN) unique high-quality downlight system for accent lighting maximum application flexibility thanks to integral pivoting lamp units

Application: shops, retail areas, presentation areas, museums

2LIGHT MDW (multi-directional wallwasher) innovative, fully flexible wallwasher reflector technology for brightening up vertical areas

Application: corridors, offices, conference rooms, waiting areas, restaurants

Design by Hartmut S. Engel Impressive looks Winner of the 2005 iF Design Award unobtrusive, flat aluminium frame in titanium colour high-quality printed safety glass panel unique Mellow Downlight effect

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 19

Benefits:

Easiest possible maintenance/easy handling 2LIGHT has a completely closed housing. At the same time, 2LIGHT is light-tight in the ceiling. The unique EasyClean catch enables quick and easy relamping.

Unique technical lighting features innovative principle of reflector splitting diffuse light: a special matt-sanded plastic panel behind the safety glass ensures a matched soft light component around the reflector. Soft, pleasantly bright light is provided. direct reflector light: light component directed downwards via facetted reflector.

20 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Models:

2LIGHT (fixed)

2LIGHT-C (pivots on gimbals)

2LIGHT MDW (multi-directional wallwasher)

2LIGHT MINI single module 2LIGHT MINI double module 2LIGHT MINI triple module 2LIGHT MINI surfacemounted 2LIGHT single module

2LIGHT double module

2LIGHT triple module

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 21

Overview:

22 / Chapter 3
Protection class IP 44 Accessories Colour filter Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Interchangeable reflectors Mounting kit for thin ceilings IP 44 IP 44 IP 44 IP 40 IP 44 Colour filter Mounting kit for thin ceilings Colour filter Mounting kit for thin ceilings Colour filter Colour filter for soft light component Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Multi Directional Wallwasher Colour filter for soft light component Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Multi Directional Wallwasher IP 44

Type 2LIGHT MINI 2LIGHT-C MINI

Module size 118 x 118 mm

Mounting depth Lamp(s) 100 mm CDM-TM 20/35 W QT-LP to 75 W

118 x 118 mm

120 mm

256 x 118 mm

103 mm

373 x 118 mm

103 mm

2LIGHT MINI single module 2LIGHT-C MINI double module 2LIGHT-C MINI triple module 2LIGHT MINI Surface-mounted 2LIGHT/ 2LIGHT MDW single module

127 x 127 mm x (height) 175 mm 216 x 216 mm 152 mm

LED WN/WW or LED RGB/W new! CDM-TM 20/35 W QT-LP to 50 W CDM-TM 20/35 W QT-LP to 50 W CDM-TM 20/35 W QT-LP to 75 W TC-TELI 1x32/42 W HIT-TC-CE 1x20/35/70 W HIT-CE 1x35/70 W

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

2LIGHT/ 2LIGHT MDW double module

408 x 216 mm

152 mm

TC-TELI 2x32/42 W HIT-TC-CE 2x20/35/70 W HIT-CE 2x35/70 W

The Lighting Handbook

2LIGHT/ 2LIGHT MDW triple module

600 x 216 mm

152 mm

Colour filter for soft light component Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Multi Directional Wallwasher IP 44

IP 44

2LIGHT-C single module

216 x 216 mm

152 mm

TC-TELI 1x32/42 W TC-L 1x80 W/2x55 W T-16 3x24 W HIT-TC-CE 1x20/35/70 W HIT-CE 3x35/70 W TC-TELI 1x32/42 W HIT-TC-CE 1x20/35/70 W

www.zumtobel.com/productsites
IP 44 Colour filter for soft light component and directional light Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Interchangeable reflectors Colour filter for soft light component and directional light Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Interchangeable reflectors Colour filter for soft light component and directional light Casting surround Mounting kit for thin ceilings Interchangeable reflectors IP 44

2LIGHT-C double module

408 x 216 mm

152 mm

TC-TELI 2x32/42 W HIT-TC-CE 2x20/35/70 W

2LIGHT-C triple module

600 x 216 mm

152 mm

TC-TELI 3x32/42 W HIT-TC-CE 3x20/35/70 W

Chapter 3 / 23

PANOS L and H Multi-talented downlights


PANOS L recessed depth of just 100 mm maximum efficiency levels PANOS H satisfies the most stringent glare limitation requirements without the need for accessories

Reflectors and their applications

HF/LF The precision-shaped facets provide brilliant effects, reduced luminance levels and optimum efficiency.

HG/LG Highly specular darklight reflector optic for glare-free working at the highest level.

HM/LM Good looks are guaranteed by this matt reflector optic with reduced dust sensitivity.

HL/LL The white reflector optic is a perfect match for the decorative accessories. Design by Sottsass Associati

24 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

HWW The special ribbed structure of the reflector produces asymmetrical light distribution, ideal for highlighting vertical surfaces.

PSP+ (Pure Silver Plated+) brilliant new finish for downlight with silber-plated reflector What is innova glare control in conformity tive about the with EN 12464 standard, new PSP+ surface is already without using technical lighting accessories revealed by its name: Pure Silver Plated+ 100 % silver, optimum reflection so-called high-purity silver, is of heat precisely applied onto the longer lamp service life high-quality polycarbonate thanks to reduced temreflectors of the PANOS L+H peratures ranges by means of sputtering, ideal temperature manand sealed. Facetted, smooth agement allows lamps to and wallwasher finishes are operate in optimum output available. range Benefits: tremendous light output light output ratio increased by as much as 21% increased lighting level leads to reduced maintenance factor innovative surface stability extremely durable and ultra-hard reflector surface excellent maintenance qualities iridescence-free reflector

Finest aluminium and silver plating by sputtering Sputtering is a unique, highquality 4-chamber metallising process applied at high vacuum. Benefits: optimum lighting effect at high efficiency levels, perInstallation instructions No-tool installation The mounting ring made of die-cast aluminium is fitted without tools using spring clips. Combined refl./flange unit The reflector/flange unit is installed by means of a twist and lock mechanism without any tools. The ballast box has a rapid locking device and forms a pre-assembled luminaire unit with the reflector. fect glare control and ideal light distribution high-quality appearance with darklight effect and iridescence-free reflector extremely easy maintenance and easy cleaning

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 25

PANOS M/MWW Impressive and powerful


PANOS M Metal reflector for high temperature resistance. Mounting rings and cooling attachments made of die-cast aluminium. Ideal for use with lamps that generate a lot of heat.

PANOS M LG/HG and PANOS M LM/HM Outstanding surface properties and optimum thermal management ensure maximum luminous flux when fitted with 2 x 42 W TC-TELI. The luminaire is light-tight in the ceiling, and can be operated completely closed with IP54. It is ideal for use with strict fire regulations.

PANOS MWW As regards its look on the ceiling, the wallwasher with asymmetrical light distribution is not different from rotationally symmetrical luminaires. It does not interfere with the interior design. Wide range of lamps With the wide range of lamps that can be fitted, PANOS M and MWW give lighting designers maximum freedom for professionally setting the lighting stage. 26 / Chapter 3 www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

PANOS S Incredibly versatile, providing more freedom for vertical adjustment

With PANOS S fully swivelled out to 60, it is possible to illuminate a wall from its top edge.

As the lighting head and the housing are separately adjustable, specific areas can be shaded.

For illumination of different levels of shelving, PANOS S can be swivelled into the ceiling by up to 45.

Suitable reflectors for any situation Comparing light distribution/room: length 5 m, height 3 m Accent lighting by PANOS S150 with HIT G8.5

4 x PANOS S150 FL 70 W
500 700 900 1100 1300 1500

Accent lighting by PANOS S200 with HIT G12

4 x PANOS S200 FL 70 W
500 700 900 1100 1300 1500

Wallwashing by PANOS S250 with HIT-DE


The Lighting Handbook

500

700

900

1100

1300

1500

3 x PANOS S250 70 W Chapter 3 / 27

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

PANOS Q Square downlight for uncompromising looks and lighting technology


Perfect one-piece reflector base Consistently square reflector, light-tight, made of high-quality UV-resistant polycarbonate for perfect light distribution.

Persuasive freedom of design various reflector optics: faceted, smooth, matt and painted various cover frames: white, titanium, chromium, frameless
PANOS Q Low

trendy attachments fitted as block or frame suspended attachment and technical lighting accessories

PANOS Q High

Reflector models faceted smooth matt white

Frame models titanium chrome white

frameless model

Attachments

Attachments

28 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Less installation time PANOS no-tool quick installation shift & lock system for fixing cover frame quick and easy subsequent installation of attachements

The Lighting Handbook

Type PANOS L

Ceiling cut-out Light sources 175/200/250

PANOS H

PANOS M

100/150/200/250

Reflector optic Light distribution faceted, smooth, painted, matt faceted, smooth, painted, matt, wallwasher smooth, partly structrured

Features high light output ratio, mounting depth only 100 mm, variety of surface finishes perfect glare control, DSE-compatible without attachment, illumination of vertical areas huge variety of light sources, consistent appearance, flat circular design

Overview of the PANOS range

PANOS M LG/HG 200/250 PANOS M LM/HM PANOS MWW 150/200

smooth, matt asymmetrical

PANOS S

100/150/200/250

spot, flood

general lighting with high wattages, lhousing light-tight uniform illumination of vertical areas, calm, uniform ceiling look uncompromising flexibility, can be swivelled in and out, highly convenient control

www.zumtobel.com/productsites
for ceilings without mounting depth, reduced building and installation costs, large variety of surface finishes perfect one-piece reflector base, optimum, glare control (DSE-compatible), exceptional, design freedom (colours + attachments) 1000 lm/2000 lm white light or 1000 lm BioMotion 2700/6500 K, high light output ratio, perfect glare control, long service life, energy-efficient, IR/UV-free light

PANOS A/AD

Surface-mounted

PANOS Q

190/190 250/250

faceted, smooth, painted, matt, wallwasher faceted, smooth, painted, matt

Chapter 3 / 29

PANOS LED

150

smooth, painted matt

PASO II Recessed floor luminaire system


PASO II knows just how to hit all the right buttons when it comes to setting dramatic contemporary lighting scenes whilst nevertheless remaining unobtrusive itself. The luminaire housing and covers are Models: PASO II D/Q 120 LED with LEDOS board units and PowerLED QR-CBC and PAR 16 MicroLynxF 7 W compact fluorescent lamps PASO II D/Q 190 QR-CBC and QR 111 TC-TEL compact fluorescent lamps HIT-TC-CE 20 W PASO II D/Q 260 PAR 38 TC-TEL compact fluorescent lamps LED floor lighting tile HIT up to 70 W, HST 50 W Application: shops & display windows galleries & showrooms hotels & wellness Benefits: flush with floor or overlapping frame without visible screw heads glass-only model models with reduced surface temperature to protect people and property 30 / Chapter 3 round or square. A generous helping of lighting technology packed into models ranging in size from small to large allows fine-tuning to provide customised lighting solutions.

(120 mm or side length)

(190 mm or side length)

(260 mm or side length) prestigious private settings, indoor and outdoor areas

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

patented sealing system to protect against penetration of surface water various technical lighting accessories

Pros: PASO II with LED technology luminaires with LED boards for decorative pinpoint lighting in static version or with variable RGB colours PASO II everything in the right light Guiding light

luminaires with PowerLEDs for lighting columns lighting tile with variable RGB colours, for recess into floor

Spot and superspot

Floodlighting PASO II extra low-profile design Use in screeded floors, without impacting on the structural calculations of concrete ceilings

Wallwashers

100 mm

PASO II D/Q range, low-profile design


190 mm HIT 20 W compact fluorescent lamps up to 10 W TC-DEL 260 mm HIT 20 W compact fluorescent lamps up to 18 W TC-DEL 370 mm HIT bis 70 W compact fluorescent lamps up to 18 W TC-DEL/TC-F 36 W

The Lighting Handbook

PASO II accessories for an impressive yet safe presence colour filters for coloured honeycomb meshes for glare accent lighting control casting surround for quick IR blocking filters for reducing and safe installation surface temperature mounting kit for cavity floors/ anti-slip glass panel available hollow ceilings for fixing PASO upon request II luminaires with overlapping IP 67 general-purpose box for frame cover external control gear (PASO II S) www.zumtobel.com/productsites Chapter 3 / 31

VAERO Waveguide luminaire providing soothing light for people and rooms

Design by Hartmut S. Engel Ingeniously designed VAERO waveguide luminaire with MPO lighting technology for maxiBalance between energy efficiency and lighting quality The sandwich construction of the micropyramidal optic lets the light really sparkle. Together with two other layers, mum energy efficiency. 2 designs available structured and homogeneous. it forms an optical system that ensures glare control in conformity with relevant standards at flat angles (EN 12464) and reduced luminance at steep angles.

Diffusor layer Micro-pyramidal layer for directing light Base

32 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

The Photometric examination of new lighting systems research carried out at TU Ilmenau demonstrates that systems using MPO technology obtain excellent values with respect to contrasts in the room, in the task area and on the screen.

Via adjustable reflectors, the light distribution curve of the luminaires indirect component can be adjusted to the suspension height of the luminaire.

Lighting quality created by contrast engineering

Contrasts in the room Brightness perceived at the workplace is determined not only by illuminance in fact, ceilings and walls have a

major impact, too. Balanced luminance levels create a pleasant, natural working atmosphere.

Contrasts between ceiling and luminaire Bright ceilings open up a room. The luminaires and their luminance levels blend

harmoniously into the brightness pattern of the ceiling. The variable pendant length of VAERO and adjustable indirect components are unique.

Contrast rendition in the task area Visual contrasts in the task area are determined by luminance ratios, e. g. ink colour on background.

The reduced luminance of the MPO diffuser helps to improve contrast rendition (see TU Ilmenau research).

Contrast rendition on screens In every location, and no matter what the angle of inclination, screens must remain
The Lighting Handbook

free from annoying reflections. Thanks to the MPO diffuser and reduced luminance , the viewability of computer screens is excellent.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 33

LIGHT FIELDS Modular micro-pyramidal lighting system

Design by Sottsass Associati Pure innovation for the office Micro-pyramidal optic Even in surface-mounted and recessed luminaires, the sandwich construction of the micro-pyramidal optic ensures both glare control in conformity with standards and reduced luminance for direct illumination ideal for office lighting according to standard EN 12464.

diffuser layer

34 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

base micro-pyramidal layer for directing the light

Available as recessed/surface-mounted/pendant/ free-standing or cluster luminaires, they are ideal for the more stylish office, with EN 12464 compliance over a range of ceiling heights and floor areas.

Recessed 1198 x 298 2/28 W T16 1498 x 298 2/35 W T16 598 x 598 4/14 W T16 1248 x 310 2/28 W T16 1548 x 310 2/35 W T16 623 x 623 4/14 W T16

Surfacemounted 1248 x 310 2/28 W T16 1548 x 310 2/35 W T16 623 x 623 4/14 W T16

ID pendant 1248 x 310 2/54 W T16 1548 x 310 2/49 W T16 623 x 623 4/24 W T16

Free-standing luminaire 3/55 W TCL 3/80 W TCL

LIGHT FIELDS model Recessed L-FIELDS E 4 x 4/14 W T16 L-FIELDS E 4 x 2/28 W T16 L-FIELDS E 4 x 2/28 W T16 L-FIELDS E 6 x 4/14 W T16 Surface-mounted L-FIELDS A 4 x 4/14 W T16 L-FIELDS A 4 x 2/28 W T16 L-FIELDS A 3 x 2/35 W T16 L-FIELDS A 4 x 2/28 W T16 L-FIELDS A 6 x 4/14 W T16

M 625

M 600

1-person office

2-person office

3-person office

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 35

MELLOW LIGHT IV A piece of sky Balance, energy efficiency and lighting quality
Owing to their light distribution characteristics, MELLOW LIGHT IV surface-mounted and recessed luminaires bring a piece of sky into the room. Design by Studio & Partners Technical lighting features: bright visible luminance levels create an attractive impression of brightness light is distributed uniformly in the room. In the process, not only is a high level Efficiency level of 57 %: MELLOW LIGHT IV with slotted sheet steel controller optic and 55 W TC-L lamp Efficiency level of more than 70 %: MELLOW LIGHT IV with microprismatic optic and 55 W TC-L lamp of uniformity achieved on the useful plane, but room peripheries such as ceilings and walls can be selectively brightened up as well. This allows for active brightness management.
100

50

0 100

Efficiency level of 67 %: MELLOW LIGHT IV with slotted sheet steel controller optic and two 24 W T5 lamps Effiency level of more than 80 %: MELLOW LIGHT IV with microprismatic optic and two 24 W T5 lamps

50

Bright, pleasant room impression or cave effect with convenwith MELLOW LIGHT IV tional solutions using louvre luminaires. 36 / Chapter 3 www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Application and glare control

Direct and reflected glare on upright and steeply inclined displays is minimised, allowing for lighting solutions in conformity with the EN 12464 standard.
40 90 Laptops 55 90 Flatscreens 65 90 Conventional display

0 10 Organizer

0 40 Displays

The more strongly inclined a computer display is, the higher are the requirements for glare control of the lighting system in particular where it has been installed directly above the workstation.

Micro-prismatic optic with cross pattern innovative optic for maximum energy efficiency gentle light for ergonomically beneficial lighting conditions in line with the basic concept of Mellow Light screening prevents direct view of light source ideal for upright and inclined displays (luminance reduced at all angles of view) free arrangement in the room, without taking position of workstation into account (demonstrated by TU Illmenau research) Slotted sheet steel controller optic design-oriented slotted sheet steel controller optic gentle light for ergonomically beneficial lighting conditions

in line with the basic concept of Mellow Light screening prevents direct view of light source ideal for upright and inclined displays (luminance reduced at all angles of view) free arrangement in the room, without taking position of workstation into account (demonstrated by TU Ilmenau research) Louvre optic classic with louvre technology in conformity with relevant standards combination of proven, efficient louvre technology and the typical gentle lighting effects of Mellow Light glare control for upright displays meets specifications of EN12464 (with or without extra filter, depending on luminaire model) Chapter 3 / 37

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

CIELOS Modular luminous ceiling for creating designs with light and colour

Design by Nicholas Grimshaw & Partners Application: Luminous ceilings capture our attention. Wide-area, diffuse lighting fascinates the viewer. Combined with selective accents, a rooms ambience can be changed radically.

entrance areas conference and meeting rooms shops

Models: 2 heights: 80 mm and 150 mm 80 mm for white and monochrome 150 mm for RGB from 4/14 W to 12/21 W

600 x 600 mm 900 x 900 mm dynamic colour changes, controlled via EMOTION Touch

38 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Pros: Conventional luminous ceilings use almost no lighting technology at all. They rely exclusively on maximum clearance between lamp and diffuser in order to produce uniform illumination.

Mounting heights often range from 300 to 700 mm, yet hardly any of these luminous ceilings offers the same colour neutrality and infinite colour spectrum as CIELOS.

Coloured lamps or sheathing the T16 light sources in coloured film produces coloured light. Special coloured films that emit especially intense, pure light were developed for CIELOS. They are available as accessories in the three primary colours red, green and blue. Any other coloured film suitable for use in luminaires can also be used.

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 39

CLARIS II Luminaire system


Minimised design with improved technical lighting features. Its angular shape and clear lines are unmistakable features of CLARIS II. Complete range: indirect/direct pendant luminaire surface-mounted luminaire wallwasher Application: offices and schools Lighting technology: miniature cell louvre used DSE-compatible luminaire

Design by ag Licht, Bonn

meets requirements for lighting of office areas according to EN 12464

Optics for all applications: Darklight louvre specular louvre ensures ideal glare control according to EN 12464 Matt comfort louvre bright, friendly room atmosphere in conformity with EN 12464 standard Surface finishes: powder-coated titanium or natural anodised finish

Opal diffuser closed luminaire diffuse light distribution harmoniously soft light creates communicative room atmosphere

Easy design: easy design is ensured by standard module lengths


The Lighting Handbook

40 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Practical technology Lamps are replaced straightforwardly from the top of the luminaire. Thanks to the convenient lever, releasing and replacing the light source is childs play. Installation: time is money Invisible height adjustment inside, adjustment in longitudinal direction

All inclusive Luminaire includes pre-installed suspension assembly, transparent connecting cable already fitted, light source already integrated, plus protective film Can be used for continuous row lighting CLARIS II configurations Continuous row luminaires (pendant luminaires): indirect/direct direct only indirect only wallwasher Connectors for continuous design
300 225 225 225 300 150 300

The Lighting Handbook

300

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 41

RTX II Design-oriented continuous row lighting system

Design by Charles Keller Avant-garde in terms of both material and shape Application: offices and schools

Individual luminaires and continuous row systems: Pure aluminium Matt bivergent or darklight reflector optic Wallwasher for illuminating blackboards Decorative optics

Typical applications
RTX II-C
1/35W 1/49W 1/54W 1/80W 2/28W 2/35W 2/49W 2/54W

Day school Technical college/ evening school Office Office with DSE Open-plan office Technical drawing

RTX II-D
1/35W 1/49W 1/54W 1/80W 2/28W 2/35W 2/49W 2/54W

42 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Day school Technical college/ evening school Office Office with DSE Open-plan office Technical drawing

RTX II Wallwasher
RTX II 1 x 49 W RTX II 1 x 54 W RTX II 1 x 80 W RTX RTX RTX RTX II II II II 2 x 28 W 2 x 35 W 2 x 49 W 2 x 54 W

300 Lux
(Day school)

0.20

0.40 0.60 0.80 1.00 1.20 1.40 blackboard luminaire distance [m]

optimum range possible range possible range under certain conditions*

* Use strongly depends on architectural parameters and luminaire arrangement.

RTX II 1 x 80 W RTX II 2 x 49 W RTX II 2 x 54 W

500 Lux
(Evening school and technical colleges)

0.20 0.40 0.60 0.80 1.00 1.20 1.40 blackboard luminaire distance [m]

optimum range possible range possible range under certain conditions*

The Lighting Handbook

* Use strongly depends on architectural parameters and luminaire arrangement.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 43

MIRAL T16 Surface-mounted louvre luminaire


Complete louvre luminaire range: surface-mounted luminaire indirect/direct pendant luminaire wallwasher Application: offices, schools, shops Benefits: BIVERGENZ plus lighting technology quick installation thanks to mounting bracket externally located terminal block pre-fitted lamp protective film Lay in Fold up Snap in

Design by Studio Ambrozus Light source included MIRAL T16 is pre-fitted with an LF840 lamp (optionally LF830). This keeps the installation effort to a minimum, saving the time, resources and energy that would otherwise be spent on lamp procurement, transport and temporary storage. Packaging The mounting brackets are located ready for use outside the box so there is no need to open it. Advantage: the luminaire remains protected in its packaging during preinstallation. Electrical connection Quick installation is also guaranteed thanks to the exactly centered 5-pole plug-in terminal (CE-compliant) easily accessible from outside the luminaire. Thus the connecting cable can be fitted conveniently and in minimum time without needing to open the luminaire housing. Protective film A special self-adhesive protective film made of recyclable material offers optimum protection against louvre soiling. MIRAL T16 can therefore be fully installed whilst building work is still in progress, and even used to light the construction site. Once the building is finished, simply pull away the film which leaves no residue.

44 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Traditional installation

MIRAL T16 installation

Traditional installation for the electrician meant four trips up and down the ladder, two operations with the electric screwdriver. MIRAL T16 installation for the electrician means getting the same result in half the time!

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 45

FREELINE The TASK AREA luminaire


TASK AREA luminaire for task area-related indirect/ direct lighting luminaires are arranged between room axes, directly above workstation and at right angle to window one luminaire per workstation ensures lighting conditions in conformity with relevant standards

Design by Ingenhoven and Partner Architekten

FREELINE (matt bivergent louvre)

FREELINE (MPO technology) 46 / Chapter 3 www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Lighting technology: matt bivergent louvre for optimum lighting conditions at the workstation Wattages: 1/54 W + 2 x 2/24 W T16 1/80 W + 2 x 2/24 W T16 2/54 W + 2 x 2/24 W T16 Models with electronic ballast, DALI-dimmable or dimming-on-demand function (LDoD)

Designed by: IOA (Ingenhoven Overdiek Architekten)/Dsseldorf Dimensions: length 2436 mm (54 W) or length 2736 mm (80 W) width 98 mm height 62 mm weight: 4.5 kg Material: extruded aluminium, natural anodised finish

Lighting technology: micro-pyramidal optic with glare-free light radiation characteristics Wattages: 2 x 1/49 W T16 2 x 1/54 W T16 2 x 1/80 W T16 Models with electronic ballast, DALI-dimmable or dimming-on-demand function (LDoD)

Designed by: IOA (Ingenhoven Overdiek Architekten)/Dsseldorf Dimensions: length 2436 mm (54 W) or length 3036 mm (80 W) width 98 mm height 62 mm weight: 4.5 kg Material: extruded aluminium, natural anodised finish

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 47

Free-standing uplights LIGHT FIELDS-S, MINIUM LITE, KAREA, LANOS ...


Free-standing uplights provide maximum flexibility when changing or reorganising ones place; can be positioned freely at the workplace; focus light onto the visual task area; can be personalised, are customised and energyefficient; can be installed quickly, easily, as required and independent of the building; dont have to be installed on/in the ceiling, allow for low level heights.

LIGHT FIELDS-S Brilliant light thanks to innovative MPO-PLUS technology Design by Sottsass Associati indirect/direct distribution asymmetrical indirect component 3/55 W or 3/80 W TC-L direct component via micropyramidal optic glare reduction L<1000 cd/m2 (3/55 W) reflector can be swung open for easy cleaning flat luminaire head made of anodised aluminium backlit decorative frame attached

MINIUM LITE Max. energy efficiency and reduced installed load Design by Engel & Zimmermann indirect/direct distribution 2 x 1/55 W or 2 x 1/80 W TC-L large direct component with cell louvre in darklight or matt comfort optic glare reduction L<1000 cd/m2 two separate luminaire heads made of anodised aluminium heads pre-assembled for extremely quick installation stand made of anodised aluminium U-shaped steel base

48 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

KAREA Flexible design unobtrusive appearance Design by DaCosta & Wolf indirect/direct distribution 4/55 W TC-L direct component via perforated metal optic flat luminaire head angular aluminium stand with asym. or symmetrical luminaire-head connection U-shaped or square base (steel) colours: titanium, or silver microstructure paint available in heights of 1850 mm or 2000 mm

LANOS Pleasant lighting effect in a classic design Design by DaCosta & Wolf indirect/direct distribution 4/55 W TC-L luminaire head with lateral perforated metal refractors rounded aluminium stand with asymmetrical or symmetrical luminaire-head connection U-shaped or square steel base colours: titanium, or silver microstructure paint available in heights of 1850 mm or 2000 mm

The Lighting Handbook

SwitchDim and SensControl allow users to adjust the lighting to meet their personal requirements. From simple switching and dimming through to fully automatic control using presence detectors and brightness sensors, free-standing uplights by ZUMTOBEL provide the perfect solution meeting any requirement. SensControlDALI goes even further by using DALI to integrate the free-standing uplight into the buildings lighting management system.

SwitchDim Simple dimming and switching using momentary-action switches SensControl Fully automatic control based on daylight and the users presence SensControl-DALI additional option for link to LITENET lighting management systems

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 49

LED luminaires From semiconductor to lighting innovation


Static and dynamic light Benefits of LED technology: long service life = low maintenance costs low power consumption = minimum operating costs vibration and impact-proof compact size Benefits of LED technology in comparison with low-voltage halogen

high colour stability efficient control thanks to simple control system low heat generation light without IR/UV

In comparison with low-voltage halogen, light without IR/UV in particular, and consequently the absence of any heat radiation, is one of the main benefits. The energy efficiency of LEDs greatly exceeds that of low-voltage halogen luminaires. In comparison with compact fluorescent lamps, the benefits are slightly smaller. In addition to conservational lighting and long maintenance intervals, projected light is a main benefit. The light can be optimally directed into the area required by means of lens optics, which means that the illumination output can be used much more efficiently. Moreover, cove lighting in dynamic colours can be generated in a space-saving and energy-efficient manner, e.g. by means of LED RGB lighting solutions.

Benefits of LED technology in comparison with fluorescent lamps

50 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Limits of LED technology

Today, the LED is less energyefficient than the following lamp technologies: fluorescent lamps: 80100 lm/W high-pressure halogen lamps: 90100 lm/W high-pressure sodium vapour lamps: 100120 lm/W LEDs: 4080 lm/W LEDs dont like high ambient temperatures. If LEDs are used at high ambient temperatures (e.g. sauna, etc.), this will strongly effect luminous flux and reduce the LEDs service life. High-performance LEDs generate a lot of heat at the board side. In order to ensure a service life of 50,000 hours for an LED luminaire, the boards must be properly cooled (e.g. cooling fins, ventilator or water cooling).

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 51

Typical applications

Properties 1000 lm projected light colour temperature adjustable from 27006500 K stand-alone variation has a 4-button control panel for setting colour temperature with six pre-defined steps RGB colour dynamism via EMOTION touch panel or DMX colour temperature adjustable from 27006500 K RGB colour dynamism via DMX

1000 lm and 2000 lm as an alternative to 18 W/26 W compact fluorescent lamps colour temperatures of 3000 K and 4000 K

1000 lm projected light colour temperature adjustable from 27006500 K RGB colour dynamism via EMOTION touch panel or DMX

swivelling recessed downlights for decorative accent lighting

350 lm projected light as an alternative to 20 W low voltage halogen indirect RGB light for mellow downlight effect in dynamic colours

1000 lm as an alternative to 18 W compact fluorescent lamps colour temperatures of 3000 K and 4000 K

1100 lm projected light with 3000 K 1300 lm projected light with 4000 K projected LED accent light as an alternative to 75 W low voltage halogen

* with 24 V and 350 mA luminaires, dimmability is dependent upon type of control gear!

52 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Supply 230 V

Switchable/ dimmable* switchable, dimmable DALI (via Emotion touch panel), dimmable DMX dimmable DALI, dimmable DMX

Monochrome/ RGB control of white light via RGB RGB

Indoor/outdoor applications indoor applications

Product

TEMPURA spotlight

230 V

control of white light via RGB RGB

indoor applications

TEMPURA downlight

230 V

switchable, dimmable DALI

white

indoor applications

PANOS PureWhite

230 V

dimmable DALI (via Emotion touch panel)

control of white light via RGB RGB

indoor applications

PANOS BioMotion

350 mA

switchable, dimmable

white blue

indoor applications

PANOS S

24 V

switchable, dimmable DALI

RGB + white

indoor applications

2LIGHT MINI RGB/W

230 V

switchable, dimmable DALI

white

indoor applications

2LIGHT MINI PureWh.

230 V

switchable, dimmable DALI (via Emotion touch panel)

white

indoor applications

VIVO LED

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 53

Typical applications

Properties 300 lm projected light 3000 K and 4700 K colour temperatures

system combines miniaturised LED spots for accent lighting with T16 fluorescent lamps for wallwashing LED light lines for room illumination and atmospheric lighting effects

single and nine-fold modules nine-fold modules feature dynamic light design whereby the individual lighting cubes can be randomly dimmed up and down

colour temperature via control button in six pre-defined steps from 27006500 K luminaire is part of the SCONFINE pendant luminaire series

illuminance in accordance with EN 1838 for additional emergency lighting close to ground level unique lens/reflector optic ensures optimal light distribution on the floor available in colour temperature of 3000 K/5000 K modular LED light line system for individual, slot and channel mounting not suitable for installation in floors!

modular LED light line system for individual, slot and channel mounting SYSTEMLED Deco Basic optimised for cove lighting not suitable for installation in floors!

IP 68 version for underwater lighting walk-over capacity to max. 1000 kg

* with 24 V and 350 mA luminaires, dimmability is dependent upon type of control gear!

54 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Supply 24 V

Switchable/ dimmable* switchable, dimmable

Monochrome/ RGB white

Indoor/outdoor applications indoor applications

Product

MICROS

24 V 230 V

switchable, dimmable (light lines)

white RGB (light lines)

indoor applications

SUPERSYSTEM

230 V

switchable

monochrome

indoor applications

SCONFINE CUBO

230 V

switchable, dimmable

white

indoor applications

SCONFINE SFERA

230 V 350 mA

switchable, dimmable

white blue

indoor applications outdoor applications


ORILED

24 V

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


SYSTEMLED FLOOD

24 V

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


SYSTEMLED DECO

230 V 24 V

switchable, dimmable

yellow red green white blue

indoor applications outdoor applications


LEDOS M

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 55

Typical applications

Properties 8 mm mounting depth allows installation in parquet, tiles and laminated flooring suitable for installation in furniture walk-over capacity to max. 250 kg

accent spotlight (spot/flood) walk-over capacity to max. 1000 kg

available in colour temperature of 3000 K/5700 K uniformly illuminated light points or surfaces walk-over capacity to max. 1000 kg

diffuser with transparent sides gives the luminaire unit a floating appearance model without frame also available

extremely easy wiring via self-tapping cable connector for indoor applications

walk-over capacity to max. 500 kg RGB models feature integrated DALI power supply unit also available as a wall-mounted version

also available as a decorative floor lighting tile (IP 67)

glass only model available for indoor applications walk-over capacity to max. 1000 kg

* with 24 V and 350 mA luminaires, dimmability is dependent upon type of control gear!

56 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Supply 24 V

Switchable/ dimmable* switchable, dimmable

Monochrome/ RGB white blue

Indoor/outdoor applications indoor applications

Product

LEDOS O

230 V 24 V 350 mA

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


LEDOS B

230 V 24 V

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


LEDOS

230 V 24 V

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


LEDOS II

230 V 24 V

switchable, dimmable

yellow red green white blue RGB white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


KAVA LED

230 V

switchable, RGB dimmable DALI

indoor applications outdoor applications


PHAOS LINE

24 V

dimmable

RGB

indoor applications

PHAOS lighting tile

230 V 24 V 350 mA

switchable, dimmable

white blue RGB

indoor applications outdoor applications


PASO II LED

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 57

SYSTEMLED Modular LED light lines

SYSTEMLED is a modular LED system for decorative light lines or wide-area illumination of walls. Pre-assembled plugin connectors at the modules help to reduce sources of error during installation, and minimise installation effort. The use of aluminium sections ensures optimum cooling of LED boards, which is a prereq-

uisite to reach a service life of up to 50,000 hours! Varied accessories including a mounting channel, mounting springs and a diffuser provide for a wide range of applications. SYSTEMLED can be used in both indoor and outdoor areas.

Channel installation: No-tool wiring using cables with pre-configured connectors. Using special steel springs, the modules are fitted in the channel or wall and ceiling cut-out without the use of any tools.

58 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Options for installation: Pre-assembled modules in various lengths allow to flexibly adjust the light lines to projectspecific sections. DECOLINE is perfect for illuminating coves and for creating

light lines uniformly illuminated by means of a diffuser. FLOODLINE provides uniform illumination of vertical areas (wallwashing).

individual slot channel diffuser* installation installation installation DECOLINE IP 40 DECOLINE IP 65 FLOODLINE IP 40 FLOODLINE IP 65
* In DECOLINE IP 40, the diffuser is clipped onto the LED module. For DECOLINE IP 65, modules are supplied optionally with transparent or diffuse optic.

SYSTEMLED Deco: Clip-on diffuser for perfect uniformity.

The Lighting Handbook

SYSTEMLED Deco Basic: Easy to install in the cove thanks to ready-to-connect modules inc. connecting cables.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 59

ORILED Orientation lighting close to ground level with LED


ORILED Functional is fitted with an LED optic (patent pending) that provides illuminance in conformity with the EN 1838 standard. ORILED Decorative, with its warm or blue light colour, is used in areas where the focus is on a decorative lighting effect. By using different control gear, the luminaires can be easily integrated into building management systems such as LUXMATE or the ONLITE emergency lighting system.

In emergency cases, too, additional escape route lighting is ensured via a central battery or 1 h/3 h separate battery packs. The luminaires with IP 65 protection can be used for a broad range of applications. A variety of accessories is available for easy luminaire installation.

ORILED Functional: light distribution at ground level

60 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Besides its two 1 W LEDs, the secret of ORILEDs excellent illuminance is, in particular, its reflector combined with its unique lens optic.

By means of flexible mounting brackets, the luminaires are fixed in the wall cut-out, bollard, or in the surface-mounted housing, mounting frame or casting surround. The stainless steel frame is fixed to the luminaire housing via CAMLOCK fasteners. ORILED therefore has no visible screw heads.

The Lighting Handbook

Bollard with recessed 350 mA luminaire

Recessed housing with flushfitted luminaire Chapter 3 / 61

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

HELISSA Stylish appearance with individuality for indoor and outdoor areas
The decorative HELISSA wall/ceiling mounted luminaire with protection types IP 40 and IP 65 sets both indoor and outdoor areas masterfully centre stage while saving energy. In addition to round or square glare-free optics, a discreet indirect light component creates a white or coloured lighting corona on the wall or ceiling. Emergency lighting and dimmable models, too, can be easily installed and maintained.

HELISSA round Application: indoor areas such as corridors, stairs and waiting areas applications in temporarily or permanently humid/damp environments (e.g. station concourses) aggressive environments (chlorine or saline-contaiModels:
Model HELISSA IP 40 Size D/Q 360 D/Q 450 HELISSA IP 65 D/Q 360

HELISSA square ning environments, wellness areas) outdoor areas around the house, entrance areas public spaces All applications, from inside to outside, can be implemented in the same, highquality design using one luminaire range!

62 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Lamp(s) 2/9 W TC-SEL 1/22 W T16-R 1/55 W T16-R 2/18 W TC-L 1/22 W T16-R 2/18 W TC-DEL

Benefits/pros: high-quality and efficient optimum materials for the respective application area: HELISSA IP 40: sheet steel fitting, rugged polycarbonate diffuser HELISSA IP 65: die-cast aluminium fitting, frosted glass diffuser glare-free and uniform illumination high energy efficiency; compact/fluorescent lamps operated exclusively with electronic ballast convenient and versatile easy installation HELISSA IP 40: round fitting, diffuser unit (diffuser + aluminium frame) can be installed without tools thanks to twist and lock mechanism HELISSA IP 65: round or square fitting with silicone seal and glass cover, cover frame is fixed without tools by means of CamLock fasteners

concealed screws decorative cover frame optionally in white, titanium or aluminium, brightly polished/with protective coating economically efficient and flexible luminaires are optionally switchable or analog/digitally dimmable models in all design sizes/ versions are available in the same design and size with built-in 1 h or 3 h emergency lighting unit all components are accommodated in the fitting All these features give HELISSA its unmistakable individuality.

Accessories: Set of foil filters (red, blue, yellow) to create corona For more creative scope, the lighting coronas colour can be changed by fitting foil filters.

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 63

TECTON Continuous-row lighting system


TECTON Compact

TECTON Retail

TECTON-I Industry

Design by Nicholas Grimshaw & Partners

64 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

TECTON provides flexibility Layout changes occur at ever shorter intervals in retail, business and industry, demanding maximum flexibility from any continuous-row lighting system. TECTON allows the luminaire modules to be placed anywhere on the trunking. Technical alterations to the lighting can also be made on site, with 11-pole wiring allowing any modifications in terms of brightness control or emergency lighting supply in conformity with relevant standards.

TECTON saves on installation costs The easier, the better. The specially designed power conductor integrated in the trunking revolutionises installation, making TECTON both versatile and easy to handle. Not only does this save time, but lower qualified and hence cheaper staff can do the work. All components can be combined logically and simply in the modular system, reducing TECTON installation costs by up to 60 percent through time savings, depending on the continuous row configuration chosen.

TECTON provides safety TECTON provides safety in several ways: At the design stage, by the integration of mains lighting, emergency lighting and control; By the clear separation of emergency and escape-sign luminaires in two emergency-lighting circuits; By the ONLITE emergency luminaire range that can be fully customized to the TECTON system for safety and reliability of the lighting solution in conformity with relevant standards.

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 65

TECTON High-pressure modules for shops, hypermarkets and supermarkets

TECTON-H RBS The module for flexible lighting concepts: with the swivelling luminaire head, it is easy to respond to any changes in room layout. Thanks to wideangle lighting technology, retail islands can be created using directed light, also enabling optimum illumination of gondola heads.

TECTON-H RSR Making homogeneous illuminated areas and wall surfaces come alive: using lighting technology with asymmetrical distribution, it is possible to create lighting focuses and, for instance, precisely accentuate shelves.

TECTON-H R A high-pressure module that provides highlights: wide-angle or narrow-beam lighting technology strikingly emphasises seasonal and pallet goods using directional light, pinpointed and brilliant.

66 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

TECTON-H RSRA The surface-mounted model adds refreshing lighting accents for the illumination of counters and fresh goods. Light with asymmetrical distribution in combination with special accessories such as UVA, IR, meat and cold-meat filters makes the goods displayed appear delicious and tempting.

TECTON Decorative optics


With its innovative darklight miniature cell louvre made of aluminised polycarbonate, the indirect/direct optic provides a new interpretation of ID lighting in a continuous-row lighting system. Featuring a 50 % indirect and 50 % direct light component, it is ideal for use in demanding office applications and at POS terminals in retail areas. The MELLOW LIGHT optic with its lighting chamber in diffuser pearl material and a slotted grid-mesh optic provides appropriately glarereduced light with visible luminance levels. Specific applications include prestigious and retail areas with high aesthetic requirements.

The wide-angle, purely indirect lighting characteristics of the indirect optic ensure uniformly illuminated ceilings, preferably in long corridor areas. Providing ambient lighting, it is also ideal for combination with accent lighting in retail areas.

The Lighting Handbook

The pool-light optic made of opal plastic impresses with harmonious, wide-area luminance levels on softly rounded surfaces. It is a perfect choice for wellness areas, sophisticated zonal lighting in retail areas, or cool ambient lighting at the bar.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 67

SOLINA The new high-bay reflector luminaire


The new SOLINA high-bay reflector luminaire boasts a striking cylindrical design, a relatively small height (34 cm), a die-cast aluminium housing (for the first time ever, direct and indirect lighting are combined in a high-bay reflector luminaire), and also includes a version for direct installation on the ceiling.

Design by Charles Keller Application: shop/retail, with focus on lighting fresh products architecture-centred luminaire with ceiling illumination Benefits: both lighting types, direct and indirect, can be separately switched and dimmed same lamp and reflector range as COPA D additionally reflector painted in titanium one unit variety of installation options (cord, pendant, chain, adapter) direct installation on the ceiling accessories: IP 54 glass cover, prismatic glass cover 2 food filters (M/CM+IR) 2 coloured indirect filters (red + blue) 68 / Chapter 3

industrial lighting, as traditional high-bay reflector luminaire

colour sequences possible via LED RGB combined with EMOTION touch panel or other DALI-controlled systems colour sequences possible via LED RGB, as indirect lighting components static colour situations possible via indirect colour filters in red and blue

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

One unit a variety of mounting options: cord pendant chain adapter direct installation on the ceiling Installation benefits: easy and simple installation, largely without tools luminaire prewired, no-tool electrical installation on plug-in terminal in place twist and lock mechanism makes closing luminaire easy

The Lighting Handbook

Models: indirect lighting optionally: 22 W T-R 5, LED-RGB direct lighting optionally: 4257 W TC-TELI, 60250 W QT 32, 70150 W HIT, 85 W QL, 100 W HST

reflectors: plastic reflector (translucent or painted in titanium), prismatic reflector and metal reflector (also available in titanium-painted finish)

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 69

PERLUCE Closed lighting system with excellent maintenance factor


Closed surface-mounted luminaire with increased protection type IP 50 (IP 54) PERLUCE Opal optional colour accents excellent light output ratio uniform, fully flexible light emission smooth surfaces, easy to clean excellent maintenance factor

PERLUCE louvre first closed surface-mounted louvre luminaire available on the market optional colour accents excellent light output ratio suitable for high visual requirements maintenance factor better than in open louvre luminaires smooth surfaces, easy to clean lamp and louvre protected against soiling Design by Studio Ambrozus

70 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Application: louvre: for high visual requirements in rooms where dust and dirt are present, e. g. workshops, laboratories, kitchens, classrooms and nursery schools

opal: circulation areas, staircases, waiting rooms, wellness areas, changing rooms, nursery schools and canteens

Lighting technology: T16 technology with electronic ballast louvre: Bivergence plus darklight louvre, reduced luminance levels of L < 1000 cd/m2 at 65, UGR < 19 or < 16 acc. to EN 12464; ceiling brightened up by laterally perforated upper reflector opal: opal optic, UGR < 22 or < 25 acc. to EN 12464

Quality: 1-lamp and 2-lamp models in same housing excellent light output ratio and homogeneous illumination of luminaire injection-moulded optic (generally thin luminaire walls) high stability of optic end-to-end installation without gaps luminaries can be opened easily, even when mounted end to end

Models:
PERLUCE linear PERLUCE wallwasher PERLUCE square Opal/louvre Opal 1/14 W T16 (IP 50) 1/35 W T16 (IP 54) 2/18 W TC-L (IP 50/54) 1/24 W T16 (IP 50) 1/49 W T16 (IP 54) 4/14 W TC-L (IP 50/54) 1/28 W T16 (IP 50) 1/35 W T16 (IP 50/54) 1/80 W T16 (IP 54) 1/49 W T16 (IP 50/54) 1/54 W T16 (IP 50/54) 2/35 W T16 (IP 54) 1/80 W T16 (IP 50/54) 2/49 W T16 (IP 54) 2/14 W T16 (IP 50) 2/28 W T16 (IP 50) 2/35 W T16 (IP 50) 2/49 W T16 (IP 50/54) Protection type Protection type Protection type IP 50 standard IP 54 standard IP 50 standard (IP 54) (IP 54)

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 71

SCUBA Moisture-proof diffuser luminaire with impressive problem-solving skills


Moisture-proof diffuser luminaire boasting impressive problem-solving skills (SCII, PC, PMMA, CHEMO diffuser, plastic catches, 15 slope, high-temperature and lowtemperature versions) and a unique, innovative design language (oval, aerodynamic), in various IP 65 applications (dust-proof and jet-proof). Materials use are optionally PC, PMMA, CHEMO for diffusers, and polyester (GRP) for the basic housing. SCUBA is the successor of FZ and IFP, and stands for impact resistDesigned by Massimo Iosa Ghini

S C U B A

Shockproof Chemically resistant UV-stable Benet-orientated Application-orientated

ance, chemical resistance, UVstability, user-friendliness and application-orientation.

Benefits: unique, innovative design smooth/ergonomic surfaces language and catches high light output ratio thanks 15 slope of all visible surto calculated, optimised prisfaces (recommended for food matic structure industry) innovative sealing rim between optionally with heavy-duty electronic ballast for longer basic housing and diffuser service life at high ambient special CHEMO diffuser temperatures (combines benefits of PC and PMMA) Product range with PC, PMMA or CHEMO diffuser: T26 1-/2-lamp 18 W electr. ballast, low-loss ballast; 684 mm T26 1-/2-lamp 36 W electr. ballast, low-loss ballast; 1,294 mm T26 1-/2-lamp 58 W electr. ballast, low-loss ballast; 1,594 mm T16 1-/2-lamp 28/35/49 W; 1,294 mm/1,594 mm T16 1-lamp 54/80 W; 1,294 mm/1,594 mm Special designs (available upon request): SCII, hightemperature, low-temperature, 72 / Chapter 3 emergency lighting, heavyduty electronic ballast, plastic catches, halogen-free wiring
The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Properties of diffuser materials: Polycarbonate (PC) UV-stabilised extremely impact-resistant chemically resistant, to a limited extent Polymethylmethacrylate (PMMA) 100 % UV-resistant good chemical resistance impact absorbing UV-resistance
30 25 20 15 10

CHEMO extremely UV-resistant, comparable to PMMA substantial resistance to a large number of chemicals impact resistance similar to PC

Yellowness Index

PC with UV-stabiliser PMMA and CHEMO

5 0

Weathering time (months)

60

80

100

120

Heavy-duty electronic ballasts The PC industry product range was specially designed for use in harsh industrial environments. All T16 and T26 models ensure a long service life, even under tough environmental conditions.

Comparison of service life of a PC industry ballast compared with a standard electronic ballast, taking the SCUBA luminaire as an example
Reliability

SCUBA + standard electronic ballast

SCUBA with PC industry: same service life at higher temperature

SCUBA with PC industry: double service life at the same temperature

90 %

95 %

100 %
0 10,000 20,000 30,000 40,000 50,000 60,000 70,000 80,000 90,000 100,000

service life (h)

The Lighting Handbook

Standard electronic ballast 1/58 W, at 38 C max. 2/58 W, at 32 C max. 1/36 W, at 47 C max. 2/36 W, at 35 C max.

PC industry 1/58 W, at 50 C max. 2/58 W, at 45 C max. 1/36 W, at 59 C max. 2/36 W, at 47 C max.

PC industry 1/58 W, at 38 C max. 2/58 W, at 32 C max. 1/36 W, at 47 C max. 2/36 W, at 35 C max.

Measured values refer to ambient temperature, without through-wiring. Subtract 7 C in case of through-wiring.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 73

CLEAN Three-level luminaire concept for clean-rooms


CLEAN an overview
Model CLEAN Supreme CLEAN Advanced CLEAN Classic Designs Installation Protection type type Square Linear Usable space Ceiling Surface IP 65 IP 65 mounted Recessed Recessed IP 65 IP 54 IP 54 IP 20

All luminaires boast a highquality surface finish resistant to cleaning agents and Application: In healthcare settings operating theatres laboratories air locks intensive care units emergency wards examination and treatment rooms recovery rooms hallway and corridor areas administrative areas laundries and kitchens doctors surgeries healthcare and rehabilitation centres

disinfectants, and have been given the ENEC mark for their rugged, durable design.

In industry and engineering electronics electrical engineering micromechanics biogenetics pharmaceutical and chemical companies laboratory technology genetic engineering food technology extremely critical areas of food production food industry hallway and corridor areas laundries and large-scale catering establishments

74 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

CLEAN Supreme IPA certificate for clean-room compatibility in clean-rooms in Classes 3 to 9 (ISO), issued by the Fraunhofer Institute antistatic surface finish frameless, continuous glass diffuser trouble-free operation in rooms with positive and negative pressure containment systems thanks to special valve system easy installation of luminaires, convenient relamping CLEAN Advanced IPA certificate for clean-room compatibility in clean-rooms in Classes 3 to 9 (ISO), issued by the Fraunhofer Institute cover made of anodised aluminium models with toughened safety glass or shatter-proof PMMA acrylic glass trouble-free operation in rooms with positive and negative pressure containment systems thanks to special valve system extremely resistant materials easy installation of luminaires, and high-quality workmanconvenient relamping ship CLEAN Classic cover made of anodised aluminium model with PMMA acrylic glass extremely resistant materials and high-quality workmanship

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 75

ZBOX Plug&Play Lighting control system for hotels, private dwellings and shops
Plug&Play pre-addressed and pre-programmed for hotel rooms plug-in connections locally as stand-alone system, or networked with Luxmate bus web tool for fine adjustment no licence, no special skills required, no experts needed direct connection via Ethernet (TCP/IP) transparency of costs from design through to operation can be upgraded using standard Luxmate bus components 4 control points included no addressing of luminaires, except for RGBW (DALI Broadcast) Intuitive: clear design layout and functions of control units self-explanatory symbols Emotion: lighting scenes dynamism and controlled colour changes

ZBOX-Controller: W: 372 mm H: 372 mm D: 60 mm

ZBOX-Cxx: W: 86 mm H: 86 mm D 11 mm

control concept completely focused on guest ZBOX does what guests expect day and night scenes (networked with Luxmate add-on module: radio-controlled clock)

76 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

Safety: emergency lighting can be crash channel provides integrated light if controller fails ZUMTOBEL ONLITE separate quick and easy replacement, battery luminaires preferably no special skills required NT3 versions with central moni- dimmer with autoprotect toring in case of networking facility (overload protection for lighting loads)

Main functions: scenes and individual adjustment special control concept functions adjustable via ZBOX.WEBTOOL mains cut-off device backup function with SD card (under development) ZBOX.NIGHTLOGIC day/night scenes (various scenes are called up depending on the time of day)

Pros: energy savings through lighting scenes at reduced cost lighting levels savings operating costs dimming increases service life of incandescent lamps longer maintenance cycles cost savings fast thanks to pre-addressing and plug-in connectors do it yourself using the ZBOX.WEBTOOL package optimised for workflow on site

Technical data: 8 x output (300 W) switchable via relay dimmable via DALI Broadcast (all electronic ballasts connected are dimmed simultaneously; no DALI addressing; max. of 10 DALI loads) slot for 300 VA universal dimmer (20300 VA; 0 ... 100 %) 1 x output (300 W) for RGBW control of wellness luminaire (DALI group numbers 1 4; max. 16 DALI loads) 1 x output for 1 blinds/ curtain motor 230 V-AC Energy loss: ZBOX Controller: light on 10 W (no dimmer), light off 1 W (stand-alone = full standby) 4.5 W (networked = half standby)

5 x input for DALI ZBOX Circle control unit multiple allocation (e.g. 1 x left bed + 1 x right bed + 2 x room + 2 x bathroom + 2 x hall) 2 x input Key Card and Aux 230 V-AC, potentialfree 1 x Luxmate bus connection (1 bus load) 1 x RJ45 Ethernet LAN connection for web tool and service 1 x SD card for backup/ restore (under development)

ZBOX DIMMER300: light on 0.7 W

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 77

ONLITE escape sign and emergency luminaires Combining design and functionality
All ONLITE escape sign luminaires are based on first-class lighting technology. This ensures that pictograms are uniformly illuminated at a minimum luminance level of 200 cd/m2. Each ONLITE escape sign can be supplied via three different systems. The respective type of supply is indicated by the luminaires name: NT 1/3 Separate battery supply with auto test and control test function (1 and 3 h stand-alone time) An attractive design and the use of high-quality materials guarantee not only maximum functionality and reliability, but also pleasant, unobtrusive integration with the interior design. NSI Supplied via LPS system (communication via Power Line) DALI Supplied via CPS system (communication via DALI)

230 V AC

NT 1/3 auto test no DALI bus connected fixed test cycle programmes are run automatically, displayed via bicoloured LED low installation effort

230 V AC

SB 128 Controller

78 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

DALI control line

NT 1/3 control test DALI bus connected: luminaires centrally monitored individual configuration/ monitoring of luminaires minimum testing effort fully automatic test log book max. functional reliability

NSI supply via LPS Communication with luminaires with PLC (power line control) via supply line. All luminaires can be individually controlled and monitored. maximum intrinsic safety thanks to self-contained systems easy maintenance low installation effort reduced fire load can be fully integrated into lighting management system

DALI supplied via CPS Supply via CPS, diesel generator or 2nd mains. Monitored via DALI interface. every DALI luminaire can be used as an emergency luminaire minimum maintenance effort interference-free data communication no installation of additional monitoring modules in luminaires required security function of final circuit (makes sure that luminaires can be switched on reliably if communication line is defective)

The Lighting Handbook

Design by Matteo Thun with Lutz Bsing www.zumtobel.com/productsites Chapter 3 / 79

ONLITE RESCLITE A world champion in terms of lighting technology and energy efficiency
With a Power LED and three sophisticated optics, RESCLITE paves the way to a new era of emergency lighting. Ideal light distribution thanks to optimum illumination. Only a very small number of luminaires are required for emergency lighting in conformity with relevant standards. Minimum energy consumption and maximum installed load of 5 W. Power input in non-maintained mode approx. 1.5 W. This means that only very small-scale supply and cable systems are needed. Mounting options Recessed into ceiling Minimum design effort. Completely independent from general lighting. The only design work needed is the placing of spacing tables. Extremely easy to install and maintain. Standard installation terminals for throughwiring up to 2.5 mm. Strain relief devices and covers fixed without tools ensure quick, straightforward installation.

Surface-mounted on ceiling

TECTON continuous-row lighting system


The Lighting Handbook

80 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

RESCLITE escape LED emergency luminaire for escape route lighting according to EN 1838

Mounting height in m h 2.2 2.5 3.0 4.0 5.0

Max. spacing (m) wall/luminaire a1 b1 5.9 5.7 6.4 6.1 7.1 6.7 8.1 7.4 7.5 2.3

Max. spacing (m) luminaire/luminaire a2 b2 13.4 12.9 14.6 14.0 16.4 15.7 19.5 18.5 22.0 19.9

a2 b2

a1 b1

a Emergency power supply via separate battery for 1 hour (NT1) and central battery (NSI, DALI) b Emergency power supply via separate battery for 3 hours (NT3))

Width of escape route: 2 m Minimum illuminance across width 1 m: 1 lx Uniformity higher than 40 : 1 Maintenance factor considered: 0.8

Reflection factors: 0 Complies with glare reduction acc. to EN 1838

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 81

RESCLITE anti-panic LED emergency luminaire for anti-panic lighting according to EN 1838

Mounting height in m h 2.2 2.5 3.0 4.0 5.0

Max. spacing (m) wall/luminaire a1 b1 3.4 3.1 3.5 3.1 3.2 2.6 1.5 0.9 0.9 0.7

Max. spacing (m) luminaire/luminaire a2 b2 9.3 8.9 10.1 9.5 11.1 10.5 12.9 11.6 12.4 10.4

rotationally symmetrical distribution minimum illuminance: 0.5 lx Uniformity higher than 40 : 1 maintenance factor considered: 0,8
h a2 b2 a1 b1

Reflection factors: 0 Complies with glare reduction acc. to EN 1838

a1 b1

a2 b2

a2 b2

a1 b1

a Emergency power supply via separate battery for 1 hour (NT1) and via central battery (NSI, DALI) b Emergency power supply via separate battery for 3 hours (NT3)

82 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

RESCLITE spot LED emergency luminaire for increased illuminance levels acc. to EN 1838

Min. illuminance level of 5 lx s for first-aid, fire-fighting and reporting facilities:

Mounting height in m h 2.5 3.0 4.0 5.0

of light cone in m a b 2.4 2.1 2.7 2.3 3.0 2.7 2.8

rotationally symmetrical distri- reflection factors: 0 bution complies with glare reduc minimum illuminance: 5 lx tion acc. to EN 1838 maintenance factor considered: 0,8

a, b

a, b

The Lighting Handbook

a Emergency power supply via separate battery for 1 hour (NT1) and via central battery (NSI, DALI) b Emergency power supply via separate battery for 3 hours (NT3)

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 83

Type

SurfaceLight Protection Protection Recognition mounted Pendant- Cord Wallclass range mounted suspension mounted source type on ceiling 90 wallmounted Recessed TECTON

ONLITE LOOK product overview

84 / Chapter 3

RESCLITE

LED

IP 40

cV s

ARTSIGN

LED

IP 20

cs

15 m 3)

ERGOSIGN T16 8 W IP 40 410 Lm

cs

15 m 3) 7.6 m 5)

The Lighting Handbook

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

PROOFSIGN LED LED

IP 65 1)

cs

20 m 3)

COMSIGN

T16 8 W IP 20 410 Lm

cs

28 m 3) 15 m 4)

The Lighting Handbook

COMSIGN II LED

IP 20

cs

28 m 3) 15 m 4)

PURESIGN LED

IP 40

cs

30 m 3) 15 m 4)

ECOSIGN

T16 8 W IP 65 1) 410 Lm

s 32 m wc 16 m 4)
2)

www.zumtobel.com/productsites
2) 1) with cable feed only 2) reduced to IP 40 3) acc. to EN 1838 and DIN 4844 2) 4) lt. VkF and SN EN 1838 (model for CH) 5) narrow side if mounted on the ceiling

3)

ECOSIGN safety

T16 8 W IP 65 1) 410 Lm

s wc

3)

Chapter 3 / 85

CUBESIGN TC-DEL IP 40 1/26 W

cs

90 m 45 m 4)

BELIA Single-bed luminaire Living-room ambience for medically used rooms


As a single-bed luminaire that can optionally be fitted with supply modules, BELIA provides precise examination lighting for care personnel and glare-free reading light for patients, giving them a feeling of privacy. Multifunctional types of lighting and innovative longitudinal glare control provide ample evidence of BELIAs efficiency and photometric qualities. Design by NPK Industrial Design Application: medically used rooms without high supply requirements

rehabilitation centres and nursing homes homes for the elderly

Designs: single-bed luminaire with 580 mm mounting channel for flush integration of safety sockets, call system, telecommunication and data sockets

optional connection to medical supply systems, if medical gases are needed, for instance.

86 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

One luminaire four lighting scenes:

Room lighting

Examination lighting

Reading light

Night lighting

The Lighting Handbook

L (reading light + room lighting): 1090 mm, 1390 mm L (plus night lighting): 1200 mm, 1500 mm

188

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 87

100

TETTOIA Medical supply unit Flexibility in a pleasantly smooth design


TETTOIA boasts plenty of scope for action. Thanks to three independent lighting elements, the direct/indirect luminaire provides perfect light for any situation at the press of a button and featuring convenient reset mechanisms. This means that both patient and doctor are provided with perfect convenience. Colours for the basic unit and lighting dormer can be chosen personally, the supply components are flexibly integrated. Design by NPK Industrial Design Application: medically used rooms wit high supply requirements patient rooms Modular systems: supply unit boasts flexibility in terms of both design and technology built-in lighting unit for general, reading, examination and night lighting

nursing rooms

optional supply of mainspower components, communication and data sockets, medical gases

128

162

60 228

88 / Chapter 3

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

The Lighting Handbook

32

One luminaire four lighting scenes:

Room lighting

Examination lighting

Reading light

Night lighting

Prismatic diffuser for glare-free room lighting, easy-to-clean closed designs.

Freedom of choice for colours of basic unit and lighting dormer.

The Lighting Handbook

Supply components can be installed on the front and also on the underside.

www.zumtobel.com/productsites

Chapter 3 / 89

Chapter 4

Lamps and ballasts


Lamp selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lamp characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The main lamp types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Application notes, T16 fluorescent lamps . . . . . . . . . . . A comparison of fluorescent lamps T16/T26 . . . . . . . Application notes, compact fluorescent lamps . . . . . . . Application notes, metal halide lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . Characteristics of metal halide lamps 250 + 400 W . . . Lamp descriptions acc. to LBS (ZVEI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Characteristic values of the major lamps . . . . . . . . . . . Energy efficiency of luminaires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overview of electronic ballasts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power consumption, energy savings, required power . . Overview of LED control gear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 34 5 10 11 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 23 24 28 29 30 31 32 36

Choosing the right lamp An important first decision


Choosing the right lamp depends on what is required of the lighting (see Chapter 2). For instance, incandescent lamps are still the most popular lighting option used in domestic areas to help create that cosy atmosphere. However, these lamps generate only little light, apart from having a short service life. Therefore, despite their low purchase price, energy-efficient and environmentally compatible alternatives must be used increasingly in the future. In other situations, users happily tolerate the higher purchase price of discharge lamps because their high luminous efficiency and long lifetime make them economic. Thus it is part of the expertise of the lighting designer to find the most suitable lamp for a lighting task. Lamp characteristics can essentially be specified by the following key terms:

Luminous ux/ efciency

Service life

Light colour

Colour rendition

Drop in luminous ux

Lamp characteristics

Burning position

Lamp power

Warm-up time

Re-start time

Dimming capability

The Lighting Handbook

Lamp characteristics
1. Power The electrical power consumption of the lamp as opposed to the power consumption of a system comprising lamp and ballast. 2. Luminous flux/luminous efficiency The luminous flux specifies the total amount of light generated by a lamp. The rated luminous flux is measured at a standardised measurement temperature of 25 C in units of lumen [lm]. The ratio of luminous flux to electrical power consumption gives the luminous efficiency [lm/W]. The system luminous efficiency also includes the power consumption of the ballast. 3. Service life The average service life is normally specified, being the time by which statistically half the lamps are still working (mortality), or half the lamps have failed. This test is subject to standardised operating conditions. Lamp manufacturers display this failure rate by curves. In Chapter 8, they are shown as maintenance factors (LSF). 4. Drop in luminous flux The initial luminous flux of a new lamp decreases over its time of operation (lumen maintenance), due to the ageing of its chemical and physical components. Lamp manufacturers display this drop in luminous flux by curves. In Chapter 8, they are shown as maintenance factors (LLWF). 5. Light colour The light colour describes the colour impression made by a white light source as relatively warm (ww = warm) or relatively cool (nw = intermediate, tw = cool). It is affected by the red and blue colour components in the spectrum. 6. Colour rendition The spectral components of the light determine how well various object colours can be reproduced. The higher the colour rendition index (Ra or CRI), or the lower the colour rendition group number, the better the colour rendition in comparison with the optimum reference light.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 3

7. Warm-up time Discharge lamps in particular need between 30 seconds and several minutes to warm up and output the full luminous flux. 8. Re-start High-pressure discharge lamps need to cool down for several minutes before they can be started again. 9. Dimming capability Besides incandescent and halogen incandescent lamps, nowadays all fluorescent and compact fluorescent lamps can also be dimmed over almost any range. Metal halide lamps, however, are still not approved by the manufacturers for dimming, because this may have uncontrollable effects on light quality and lamp service life. The new series of special models for indoor and outdoor applications constitute an exception. The power of highpressure sodium- and mercury-vapour lamps can be varied, but only in discrete levels. 10. Burning position Manufacturers specify the permitted burning positions for their lamps. For some metal halide lamps, only certain burning positions are allowed so as to avoid unstable operating states. Compact fluorescent lamps may usually be used in any burning position; however, important properties such as the luminous flux vs. temperature curve may vary with the position.

4 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

The main lamp types

QR-CBC

QT12

QR111

H a l o g e n

l a m p s

QT32

QT-DE

QPAR51

QPAR64

Halogen lamps For mains and low-voltage Brilliant light operation Excellent colour rendition Longer service life and Applications: retail higher luminous efficiency and domestic areas, than incandescent lamps restaurants and Easy to dim catering How they work Current flows through a filament and heats it up, just as in incandescent lamps. These lamps therefore generate a relatively large amount of heat. The halogen cycle increases the efficiency and extends the service life compared with traditional incandescent lamps. Low-voltage types are very small and are ideal for precise direction of light, but do require a transformer.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 5

l a m p s

T16/T26

T16-R

T16-R

F l u o re s c e n t

Fluorescent lamps High to very high luminous efficiency (in particular T16 HE) Good to excellent colour rendition

Long service life Extensive range of types Dimmable Application: economically efficient widearea lighting

How they work An alternating electric field generates invisible UV radiation between the two electrodes in the discharge tube. This radiation is converted into high-quality visible light in the fluorescent material. The lamps need a starting aid and a current limiting device, usually combined in an electronic ballast. The luminous flux is highly dependent on the ambient temperature.

f l u o re s c e n t

l a m p s

TC-DEL

TC-TEL(I)

TC-TEL(I)

TC-L

C o m p a c t

Compact fluorescent lamps Compact designs Applications: commer High luminous efficiency cial and high-profile Excellent colour rendition interiors, restaurants Extensive range of types and catering Dimmable
The Lighting Handbook

How they work These lamps are compact versions of the linear or circular fluorescent lamps, and operate in a very similar way. The luminous flux depends on the burning position and temperature. 6 / Chapter 4

lamps

HIT-TC-CE

HIT-CE

HIT-DE-CE

HIT-DE

HIE

HIT

Metal halide lamps High luminous efficiency Good to excellent colour rendition High colour stability for ceramic discharge-tube lamps

halide

Metal

Cannot be dimmed Applications: industrial bays, spotlighting, floodlighting, retail areas

How they work In metal halide lamps, a highly compact electric arc is produced in a discharge tube. The composition of the materials in the tube determines the light quality. A starter is needed to switch on the lamp, and the current must be limited by a ballast. Practical electronic ballasts are also available for low-power lamps.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 7

va p o u r

Sodium vapour lamps High luminous efficiency and long service life Satisfactory to poor colour rendition Can be dimmed in discrete steps Applications: industrial bays, street lighting
HST-CRI HSE HST

l a m p s S o d i u m

Colour-improved (Philips SDW): Excellent colour rendition Warm light

Long service life Application: retail areas

How they work The discharge in the linearly extended ceramic discharge tube is defined by sodium, so the light is yellowish and only suitable for special applications. The colour-improved SDW lamp by Philips is a popular choice for lighting retail areas. A starter is usually needed to switch on the lamp, and the current must be limited by a ballast. Mercury vapour lamps No starter, just ballast required Satisfactory to poor colour rendition Can be dimmed in discrete steps Applications: industrial bays, street lighting
HME

Mercury vapour lamps

8 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

How they work The high-pressure mercury vapour lamp is actually the forerunner to the modern metal halide lamp, although it provides a far poorer light quality. The lamps can be started at mains voltage, and so only need a ballast for current limiting.

LMG-IHf

I n d u c t i o n

QL By Philips only 55 W, 85 W and 165 W Excellent colour rendition Very long service life Rotationally symmetrical light distribution

Applications: areas where it is difficult to replace lamps; commercial and industrial interiors, retail, indoor and outdoor public areas

l a m p s

How they work A high-frequency electromagnetic field is coupled into the glass bulb via an antenna protruding into the bulb. This produces UV radiation which is then converted into visible light by fluorescent material, just as in fluorescent lamps. The amalgam technology used in these lamps makes their luminous flux only very slightly temperature-dependent. The lamps can only be operated using special electronic ballasts by Philips. Systems have a very long service life because the only parts subject to wear are in these ballasts. As yet there are no dimmable electronic ballasts available.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 9

Wire bond Bubble LED chip Board

LED (EOS P214 by TRIDONIC.ATCO)

e m i t t i n g

d i o d e s

( L E D s )

Light emitting diodes (LEDs) Each manufacturer uses own technology Highly efficient direct generation of coloured light Huge potential as the light source of the future

Applications: decorative indoor and outdoor applications, escape sign luminaires, visual guidance systems, innovative lighting solutions, backlighting of advertising signs, showcase and shelf lighting

How they work Light emitting diodes are modern semiconductor devices. Their properties are determined by the materials used as well as the mechanical design. The active semiconductor layer, in which radiation is produced, is sandwiched between a positive and a negative substrate. Depending on the materials used, a large variety of different colours are produced directly. White light can only be produced using fluorescent materials from blue LEDs or by mixing RGB. Today, the smallest chips have a side length of approx. 250 m (1 micrometre = 1 one-thousandth of a millimetre). LED modules are supplied with power via appropriate converters with safety extra-low voltage. They can be dimmed easily. The LEDs very long service life of several 10,000 hours can only be achieved when overheating is avoided (thermal management). Rapid increases in efficiency at a simultaneous fall in prices open up bright perspectives for the future.

L i g h t

10 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

Application notes T16 fluorescent lamps


In comparison with thicker T26 lamps (diameter: 26 mm), modern T16 lamps (diameter: 16 mm) show several different properties that must be taken into account for application. 1. Luminous flux temperature curve As for all fluorescent lamps, the lamps luminous flux is temperature-dependent. The maximum value is obtained at an optimum ambient temperature, with losses increasing at higher and lower temperatures. The T16 basically follows the same curve as the T26, but the maximum occurs not at an ambient temperature of 20 to 25 C but at about 35 C. Reason: The cool spot of T16 is not located in the centre of the lamp, but typically at one end of the tube where the manufacturer has fixed its seal. The rated luminous flux is generally specified for an ambient temperature of 25 C. For the T16, the maximum value therefore lies above this rated value. Thus luminaire efficiencies may have levels greater than 1.
% 100 80 60 40 20 T26 36 W

T26 58 W T16

-20

20

40

60

80 C

Ambient temperature

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 11

2. CSO Cool Spot Optimizer The photometric data of luminaires typically apply to a standard temperature of 25 C. Where a different ambient temperature prevails, the lamps luminous flux is also affected. In fluorescent lamps, the luminous flux declines in particular at lower temperatures. In order to increase the efficiency of luminaires fitted with T16 lamps, the so-called Cool Spot Optimizer (CSO) may be used.

The CSO effects a temperature increase at the lamp by approx. 10 to 20 degrees, resulting in a corresponding shift to the left of the T16 curve displayed (page 11).

Example: FZ 1/54 without CSO at 0 C FZ 1/54 with CSO at 0 C

approx. 60 % LB approx. 90 %
LB

In the above example, the luminous flux produced is therefore increased by 50 % and the number of luminaires required is reduced by one third, owing to the CSO. For lighting design purposes, an appropriately adjusted planned luminous flux has to be calculated. The CSO may only be used in conventional T16 28/54 W and/or 35/49/80 W lamps using cold-spot technology, and must be fitted at the lamp end (see picture).

12 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

3. Ageing/burning in Brand new lamps stabilise during the ageing phase. This is the period immediately after the lamps are switched on for the first time, when the initially encapsulated mercury is vaporised and evenly distributed in the lamp. To ensure perfect operation, one should allow a period of 2 to 4 days of operation without dimming or switching, particularly in dimming installations. Unstabilised lamps may differ in brightness and light colour, even exhibiting flickering at low dimming levels. This may have a negative impact on the lamp service life. Also, before assessing a lighting installations illuminance level and lighting quality using already aged lamps, these should be burnt in over a minimum period of 3060 minutes without dimming or switching them.

4. Lamp orientation Owing to the two electrodes (tube ends) not being identical in design, it matters how one or more lamps are fitted in the luminaires. In general, lamp ends should always have the same orientation i.e. in multi-lamp luminaires they should lie next to each other, and where lamps are positioned vertically, they should preferably also be at the bottom. For cool environments, it may make sense depending on the type of luminaire to arrange the lamp/s differently.

single-lamp normal ambient temperature

multi-lamp

cool ambient temperature

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 13

Further details for TETRIS and continuous row arrangements: Particular attention is needed for special lamp arrangements like in TETRIS (TECTON or SLOT luminaires) or in continous-row lighting systems. The so-called TETRIS arrangement provides for lamps overlapping several centimetres. This enables to compensate for the dark zone at the lamps ends. In order to provide for maximum uniformity, it is recommended to also align all lamps identically. The last lamp/s, however, should be turned so as to make the lamp end head towards the centre of the luminaire.

single-lamp

twin-lamp

In a continous-row lighting system, the maximum total luminous flux will be achieved if the lamp ends are placed next to each other, if possible. For cool environments, here too it may make sense to arrange the lamp/s differently.

single- and twin-lamp 14 / Chapter 4

single- and twin-lamp

The Lighting Handbook

A comparison of fluorescent lamps T16/T26


Advantages of T16 fluorescent lamps Reduction in the lamp diameter by about 40 % Higher optical efficiencies possible Improved luminous efficiency Improved luminaire efficiencies from the shift in the luminous-flux peak Standardised luminance levels for all lamp lengths for high-efficiency lamps Larger range of types makes it easier to meet lighting requirements more closely Summary type comparison (selection):
T16 Length Power Rated luminous flux (25 C) 549 mm 14 W 1200 lm 24 W 1750 lm 849 mm 21 W 1900 lm 39 W 3100 lm 1149 mm 28 W 2600 lm 54 W 4450 lm 1449 mm 35 W 3300 lm 49 W 4300 lm 80 W 6150 lm T26 Length Power Rated luminous flux (25 C) 590 mm 18 W 1350 lm 895 mm 30 W 1200 mm 36 W 1500 mm 58 W 2350 lm 3350 lm 5200 lm

Example of interior lighting using T16 and T26 Room dimensions: length = 8 m, width = 6 m, height = 3 m Reflection factors: ceiling = 70 %, walls = 50 %, floor = 20 % Required maintenance value of illuminance: 500 lx Option 1: SPHEROS ind/direct luminaire, matt louvre, 2/36 W electr. ballast Option 2: SPHEROS ind/direct luminaire, matt louvre, 2/28 W electr. ballast
Option 1 2/36 W Number of luminaires 8 Max. lamp luminous efficiency 93 lm/W Power consumption per m2 per 100 lx 2.2 W/m2/100 lx Luminaire efficiency 85 % Utilization factor 66 % Energy saving Option 2 2/28 W 8 104 lm/W 2.0 W/m2/100 lx 91 % 73 % 10 %

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 15

Application notes Compact fluorescent lamps


1. Amalgam lamps The strong temperature dependence of the luminous flux of traditional fluorescent and compact fluorescent lamps can be compensated by adding amalgam (mercury compound). This helps to somewhat mitigate the sharp drop at higher or lower temperatures, ensuring that more than 90 % of the maximum luminous flux is achieved over a wide temperature range of approx. +5 to +70 C. Above and below this range, however, the light level still falls off sharply. The tables provide an overview of those major manufacturers lamps in the TC-T design (three-fold double tube) that have added amalgam. Other amalgam without amalgam TC-T, TC-TE models can be 13 W 18 W 26 W 32 W 42 W 57 W found in the Osram 2-pin DULUX T T16 and TC-L Osram 4-pin designs. DULUX T/E
Philips 2-pin PL-T 2p Philips 4-pin PL-T 4p GE 2-pin BIAX T Sylvania 2-pin Lynx CF-T

with amalgam TC-TI, TC-TELI, TC-QELI


13 W 18 W 26 W 32 W 42 W 57 W 60 W 70 W 85 W 120 W Osram 2-pin DULUX T IN Osram 4-pin DULUX T/E IN DULUX HO CONSTANT Philips 2-pin PL-T TOP 2p Philips 4-pin PL-T TOP 4p PL-H GE 4-pin BIAX T/E BIAX Q/E Sylvania 4-pin Lynx CF-TE

The Lighting Handbook

16 / Chapter 4

2. Lamp orientation The luminous flux from compact fluorescent lamps is highly dependent on the burning position. Luminaire efficiency can be maximised by fitting the lamps properly in the luminaires. Standard types have a cool spot in the exposed lamp bend, so that self-heating and convection may lead to a temperature rise here. In amalgam lamps, the cool spot lies in the lamp base. In compact luminaires with horizontal lamp arrangement (e.g. downlights), it is therefore recommended to fit the lamps with electrodes uppermost wherever possible. Since the lamp end does not allow consistent identification of the electrode position, that lamp side on which adjacent tubes are not connected should be placed uppermost these are the two tube ends containing the internal electrodes. The exception to this is the PHILIPS PL-T, in which the electrodes are arranged diagonally. Either possible orientation of these lamps is equivalent.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 4 / 17

Application notes Metal halide lamps


1. Ballasts The manufacturers of metal halide lamps use a range of operating principles, resulting in different electrical operating values. Some lamps are therefore approved for operation both with ballasts for metal halide lamps (e.g. COPA I 1/400 HIE) and with ballasts for high-pressure sodium vapour lamps (e.g. COPA I 1/400 HSE). The higher operating current then leads to higher luminous flux levels for the same lamps together with a slightly altered light quality. In both cases suitable starters are required. 2. Glass covers In general, metal halide lamps require a glass cover to protect people and property in the event of the lamp exploding. It is the manufacturers responsibility to decide whether to permit individual lamp types to be used in uncovered luminaires. Suitable safety devices are installed in the lamps for this purpose (e.g. integral safety tube, outer protective coating). The detailed information from the manufacturer must be observed without fail. 3. Service life characteristics The average lamp service life (lamp survival factor) and the reduction in luminous flux (lamp luminous flux maintenance factor) can vary markedly in some of the different lamp types. They also depend on the switching frequency and the position of use. Once again the detailed data from the manufacturer must be taken into account. The maintenance factor tables in Chapter 8 contain some typical values. With these high-pressure discharge lamps in particular, it is important to replace the lamps at the designated end of their service life (maintenance interval) at the latest. Continued use may lead to damage of lamps and control gear and consequently of luminaires!

18 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

OSRAM HQI-E

HQI-E/P

HQI-T

250 W/D
Tube mini G 22 any no 20,000 h 20,000 h Ellipsoid E 40 pendant 15 no Ellipsoid E40 pendant 15 yes

250 W/D

250 W/D

PHILIPS HCI-E HCI-T HCI-TM HPI-PLUS HPI-Plus HPI-T PLUS POWERBALL POWERBALL POWERBALL 745/767 BU 745/767 BU-P 645 250 W/WDL 250 W/WDL 250 W/WDL 250 W 250 W 250 W
Tube E 40 pendant 20 no 20,000 h

Design Base Burning position Approved for operation in uncovered luminaires Average service life Reduction in lumin, flux

Ellipsoid E 40 any no

Ellipsoid E 40 any yes

Tube E 40 any no

Ellipsoid E 40 any no

Tube E 40 any no

12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 6,000 h See maintenance factors in Chapter 8 Calculation of economic efficiency

not permitted not permitted 18,000 lm 18,000 lm 20,500 lm 4,500 K/6,700 K 4,500 K/6,700 K 4,500 K 70 70 65

Characteristics of metal halide lamps 250 W

Operation with metal-halide lamp ballast (HI) Luminous flux not permitted not permitted not permitted not permitted Colour temperature Colour rendition index Ra Operation with high-pressure sodium-vapour lamp ballast (HS) Luminous flux 19,000 lm 17,000 lm 20,000 lm 24,100 lm Colour temperature 5,200 K 5,200 K 5,300 K 3,000 K Colour rendition 90 90 90 88 index Ra 24,500 lm 3,000 K 90

Chapter 4 / 19

25,800 lm 3,000 K 89

25,500 lm 25,500 lm 25,000 lm 4,000 K/5,400 K 4,000 K/5,400 K 4,000 K 70 70 65

All data subject to change. For reliable information and data on other lamp types, please refer to the manufacturers data.

OSRAM HPI PLUS 400 W 745/767 BU


Ellipsoid E40 pendant 15 no 20,000 h 20,000 h 20,000 h Ellipsoid E40 horizontal 20 no Ellipsoid E40 pendant 15 yes Tube E40 horizontal 20 no

PHILIPS HPI PLUS 400 W 743 HOR HPI PLUS 400 W 745/767 BU-P HPI-T PLUS 400 W 645

Characteristics of metal halide lamps 400 W

20 / Chapter 4
32,500 lm 30,000 lm 4,500 K/6,700 K 4,300 K 70 70 42,500 lm 35,000 lm 4,000 K/5,400 K 3,800 K 70 70 32,500 lm 35,000 lm 4,500 K/6,700 K 4,500 K 70 65 42,500 lm 42,500 lm 4,000 K/5,400 K 4,000 K 70 65

HQI-E HQI-E/P HQI-E HQI-BT HQI-T 400 W/D 400 W/D 400 W/N 400 W/D 400 W/N (clear)

Design Base Burning position Approved for operation in uncovered luminaires Average service life Reduction in luminous flux

Ellipsoid E40 any no

Ellipsoid E40 any yes

Ellipsoid E40 any no

Tube E40 any no

Tube E40 horizontal 45 no

12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 12,000 h 20,000 h See maintenance factors in Chapter 8 Calculation of economic efficiency

33,000 lm 4,100 K >60

Operation with metal-halide lamp ballast (HI) Luminous flux 26,000 lm 25,000 lm 33,000 lm 27,000 lm Colour temperature 5,800 K 5,000 K 4,700 K 6,100 K Colour rendition index Ra 90 90 58 90 Operation with high-pressure sodium-vapour lamp ballast (HS) Luminous flux 30,000 lm 31,000 lm 40,000 lm 35,000 lm Colour temperature 5,900 K 4,500 K 4,100 K 5,200 K Colour rendition index Ra 90 90 64 90

39,000 lm 3,800 K >65

All data subject to change. For reliable information and data on other lamp types, please refer to the manufacturers data.

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

LBS code

Description Philips GE Sylvania

System power Osram

Fluorescent and compact fluorescent lamps T16 /840 Fluorescent lamp 16 mm light colour 840 Starcoat T5 F/T5/840 ----------T5 Luxline Plus FHE/840, FHO/840 ---

1480 W

T16-I /830

24120 W

T16-bu

Fluorescent lamp 16 mm amalgam techn. light colour 830 Fluorescent lamp 16 mm blau

1480 W

T16-R(I)

2260 W

FH /840 HE; FQ /840 HO FQ /830 HO CONSTANT FH /67 HE; FQ /67 HO FC

MASTER TL5 HE/HO Super 80/840 MASTER TL5 HO/VHO TOP /830 TL5 HO Coloured Pro MASTER TL5C

T26 /830

Fluorescent lamp 16 mm circular (partly amalgam techn.) Fluorescent lamp 26 mm light colour 830 T8 Polylux XLR F /830 --Electronic Biax Biax S - 2 pin Biax D/E - 4 Pin Biax T/E - 4 Pin Biax L - 4 pin ---

1558 W

L /830

T26-LL

Fluorescent lamp 26 mm long service life

1558 W

T8 Luxline Plus F /830 --Mini-Lynx T /E27 Lynx-S Lynx-DE Lynx-TE Lynx-LE ---

TC-TSE

530 W

Lamp descriptions acc. to LBS (ZVEI)

TC-S MASTER PL-C 4 Pin

511 W

MASTER TL-D Super 80 /830 --MASTER TL-D Xtra/Xtreme DULUX EL E27 MASTER PL Electronic DULUX S MASTER PL-S 2 Pin

TC-DEL

1026 W

DULUX D/E

TC-TELI

1370 W

DULUX T/E IN

a comparison of models and manufacturers descriptions

TC-L ---

1880 W

DULUX L

MASTER PL-T TOP 4 Pin MASTER PL-L 4 Pin

Chapter 4 / 21

TC-LI

Compact fluorescent lamp (3 double tubes) with integral electr. ballast E27" screw-in cap Compact fluorescent lamp (1 short double tube) only for conventional/low-loss ballast Compact fluorescent lamp (2 double tubes) G24q 4-pin cap for conv./low-loss/electr. ballasts Compact fluorescent lamp (3 double tubes) amalgam techn. GX24q 4-pin cap Compact fluorescent lamp (1 long double tube) 2G11 4-pin cap Compact fluorescent lamp (1 long double tube) 42G11 4-pin cap amalgam techn.

4080 W

DULUX L CONSTANT

LBS code GE
----A1/CL/E27 R80/E27 PAR38/E27 Q MR16 HI-SPOT ES 50 DLX-T Tube satin halogen rod Halogen Axial Normal E27 transp. Refl. R80 PAR38 -----

Description Philips Sylvania


MASTER QL ---

System power Osram

Lamp descriptions acc. to LBS (ZVEI)

a comparison of models and manufacturers descriptions

22 / Chapter 4
HalogenA Pro E27 AM Plusline Pro Capsuleline Pro STARLITE Brilliantline Pro Dichroic Q T3/12V GY6.35 GY6,35 --Tubular FR K /Q T3/CL Precise MR16 /CG SUPERIA 50 AR111 12V FL ---

--ENDURA

CLASSIC A CL CONCENTRA R80 CONCENTRA

Standard A55 CL Reflector NR80 PAR38 PAR38 HALOPAR 16 GU10 Twistline Pro Alu

HALOLUX CERAM

HALOLINE

HALOSTAR

DECOSTAR

Induction lamps LMG-IHf Ball-shaped induction lamp 55165 W LMG-SIHf Double-tube induction lamp 70150 W Incandescent and halogen incandescent lamps A60 /c Incandescent GLS lamp 60 mm transp. 15100 W R80 Incandescent reflector lamp 80 mm 40100 W PAR38 Parabolic incandescent reflector lamp 60120 W 38/8" = approx. 122 mm QPAR51 /GU10 Halogen incandescent lamp for mains 3550 W voltage, with parabolic aluminium reflector 51 mm GU10 cap QT32 /m Halogen incandescent lamp for mains volt., 60250 W tube-shaped 32 mm frosted outside Halogen incandescent lamp for mains 602000 W QT-DE12 voltage, cap at both sides 12 mm QT12-ax-LP LV halogen incandescent lamp approx. 20100 W 12 mm axial filament low-pressure system Low-pressure 12 V QR-CBC51 LV halogen incandescent lamp with 2065 W cold-light specular reflector 51 mm and glass cover QR111 /24 LV halogen incandescent lamp with 35100 W reflector 111 mm Radiation angle 24

HALOSPOT 111 FL Aluline Pro 111 24D

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

LBS code
HPL-N --MASTER Colour CDM-T SuperMini CMH/T, CMH/TC CMI-TC CMI-TD UVS Britelux HSI-SX/P --ConstantColor CMH /T/UVC CMI-T UVS Arcstream ARC/T HSI-T Kolorlux Standard HSL-BW

Description Philips GE Sylvania

System power Osram

HQL

HQI-T

High-pressure discharge lamps HME High-pressure mercury-vapour lamp 501000 W ellipsoidal HIT Metal halide lamp, tube-shaped, with 35150 W quartz discharge tube HIT-CE UVr Metal halide lamp, tube-shaped, with 35250 W ceramic discharge tube, reduced UV radiation HIT-TC-CE Metal halide lamp, tube-shaped, with 2070 W ceramic discharge tube, compact design

HCI-T

HCI-TF PB, HCI-TC PB

HIT-DE-CE

HCI-TS

Lamp descriptions acc. to LBS (ZVEI)

HQI-E/P MASTER SDW-TG ---

MASTER Colour CDM-Tm, CDM-TC, CDM-Elite-TC MASTER Colour CDM-TD MASTER HPI Plus BU-P ConstantColor CMH /TD/UVC ---

---

a comparison of models and manufacturers descriptions

NAV-T SUPER MASTER SON-T Pro Lucalox LU /HO/T/40 SHP-TS MASTER SOX --SLP

Metal halide lamp, tube-shaped, cap at 70250 W both sides, with ceramic discharge tube HIE-P Metal halide lamp, ellipsoidal, with quartz 70400 W discharge tube and anti-burst tube for open luminaires HST-CRI GX12 High-pressure sodium-vapour lamp, 50100 W tube-shaped, colour-improved, GX12 cap HST-MF High-pressure sodium-vapour lamp, 501000 W tube-shaped, increased luminous flux Low-pressure discharge lamps LST Low-pressure sodium-vapour lamp, 18180 W tube-shaped

Chapter 4 / 23

SOX

ma g n e t i c l ow- l o s s b.

el ect r on i c b al l as t

24 / Chapter 4
System Lamp power service life* in W in h System power in W Max. system luLamp service life* minous efficiency in lm/W in h

Lamp name

Colour rendition Base Colour index Ra temperature

Luminous flux in lm (at 25C)

Fluorescent lamps T 16 14 W T 16 21 W T 16 24 W T 16 28 W T 16 35 W T 16 39 W T 16 49 W T 16 54 W T 16 80 W T16-I 24 W T16-I 39 W T16-I 49 W T16-I 54 W T16-I 80 W T16-I 95 W T16-I 120 W T 16-R 22 W T 16-R 40 W T 16-R 55 W T 16-R 60 W T 26 18 W T 26 36 W T 26 58 W 25 42 66 13,000 13,000 13,000 1618 24 27 3133 3941 46 54 61 approx. 88 27 46 54 61 approx. 88 approx. 105 approx. 130 26 4547 60 66 1920 36 5457 2024,000 84 2024,000 87 2024,000 74 2024,000 93 2024,000 93 2024,000 76 2024,000 90 2024,000 81 2024,000 82 24,000 72 24,000 74 24,000 88 24,000 80 24,000 approx. 77 24,000 approx. 70 24,000 approx. 71 12,000 69 12,000 71 12,000 67 12,000 76 1620,000 68 1620,000 89 1620,000 93

Characteristic values of the major lamps

ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw

80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 G5 GX5 GX5 2GX13 2GX13 2GX13 2GX13 G13 G13 G13

1,200 1,900 1,750 2,600 3,300 3,100 4,300 4,450 6,150 1,950 3,400 4,750 4,850 6,800 7,300 9,200 1,800 3,200 4,000 5,000 1,350 3,350 5,200

* Lamp service life = mean service life up to 50 % failure (exception: Philips QL up to 10 % failure)

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook ma g n e t i c l ow- l o s s b. el ect r on i c b al l as t

Lamp name System Lamp power service life* in W in h


15 17 23 31 17 23 31 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000 8,000

Colour Colour rendition Base temperature index Ra System power in W Lamp Max. system luservice life* minous efficiency in h in lm/W

Luminous flux in lm (at 25C)

Compact fluorescent lamps TC-D/-DEL 10 W ww, nw TC-D/-DEL 13 W ww, nw TC-D/-DEL 18 W ww, nw TC-D/-DEL 26 W ww, nw TC-T(I)/-TEL(I) 13 W ww, nw TC-T(I)/-TEL(I) 18 W ww, nw TC-T(I)/-TEL(I) 26 W ww, nw TC-TEL(I) 32 W ww, nw TC-TEL(I) 42 W ww, nw TC-TEL(I) 57 W ww, nw TC-TELI 60 W ww, nw TC-TELI 70 W ww, nw TC-TELI 85 W ww, nw TC-TELI/-QELI 120 W ww, nw TC-L 18 W ww, nw TC-L 24 W ww, nw TC-L 36 W ww, nw TC-L 40 W ww, nw TC-L 55 W ww, nw TC-L 80 W ww, nw TC-LI 40 W ww, nw TC-LI 55 W ww, nw TC-LI 80 W ww, nw 25 30 42 8,000 8,000 8,000 12 14 1820 28 14 1820 28 3536 4647 62 65 75 92 128 19 2527 3439 45 5561 85 45 5561 85 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 20,000 10,000 20,000 20,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000

Characteristic values of the major lamps

80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80

G24d-1/q-1 G24d-1/q-1 G24d-2/q-2 G24d-3/q-3 GX24d-1/q-1 GX24d-2/q-2 GX24d-3/q-3 GX24q-3 GX24q-4 GX24q-5 2G8 GX24q-6 2G8 2G8 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11 2G11

600 900 1,200 1,800 900 1,200 1,800 2,400 3,200 4,300 4,000 5,200 6,000 9,000 1,200 1,800 2,900 3,500 4,800 6,000 3,500 4,800 6,000

50 64 66 64 64 66 64 68 69 69 62 70 65 70 63 72 85 77 87 71 78 87 71

Chapter 4 / 25

* Lamp service life = mean service life up to 50 % failure (exception: Philips QL up to 10 % failure)

ma g n e t i c l ow-l o s s b.

el ect r on i c b al l as t

26 / Chapter 4
System Lamp power service life* in W in h
55 85 165 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 3,000 3,000 1,500 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 60,000 60,000 60,000 64 71 73 16 18 16 18 10 10 14 16 19 14 16 16

Lamp name System power in W

Colour rendition Base Colour index Ra temperature

Luminous flux in lm (at 25C)

Max. system luLamp service life* minous efficiency in lm/W in h

80 80 80

Special Special Special

3,5503,650 6,1006,300 12,000

Induction lamps LMG-IHf 55 W (QL 55 W) ww, nw LMG-IHf 85 W (QL 85 W) ww, nw LMG-IHf 165 W (QL 165 W) ww, nw Low-voltage halogen lamps QT 12 35 W ww QT 12 50 W ww QR-CBC 51 35 W (860) ww QR-CBC 51 50 W (860) ww QR 111 75 W (845) ww QR 111 100 W (845) ww High-voltage halogen lamps QT-DE 12 150 W L 114,2 ww QT-DE 12 300 W ww QT-DE 12 500 W ww QT 32 100 W matt ww QT 32 150 W matt ww QT 32 250 W matt ww

90 90 90 90 90 90

GY6,35 GY6,35 GU5,3 GU5,3 G53 G53

600 930 **70014,000 **85015,000 **1,70030,000 **2,80048,000

Characteristic values of the major lamps

90 90 90 90 90 90

R7s R7s R7s E27 E27 E27

2,200 5,000 9,500 1,430 2,400 4,000

* Lamp service life = mean service life up to 50 % failure (exception: Philips QL up to 10 % failure)

** Axial luminous intensity in cd.

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook ma g n e t i c l ow-l o s s b. el ect r on i c b al l as t

Lamp name System Lamp power service life* in W in h


8083 172 6,000 6,000

Colour Colour rendition Base temperature index Ra System power in W Lamp Max. system luservice life* minous efficiency in h in lm/W

Luminous flux in lm (at 25C)

72 ca, 160 8083 172 ca, 24 4245 8083 4245 8083 172

912,000 912,000 6,000 6,000 7,5009,000 912,000 912,000 912,000 912,000 612,000 612,000

Metal halide lamps HIE 70 W HIE 100 W HIE 150 W HIE 250 W HIE 400 W HIE 1,000 W HIE-CE 70 W (Ceramic) HIE-CE 100 W (Ceramic) HIE-CE 150 W (Ceramic) HIE-CE 250 W (Ceramic) HIT 70 W HIT 150 W HIT 250 W HIT-TC-CE 20 W (Ceramic) HIT-TC-CE 35 W (Ceramic) HIT-TC-CE 70 W (Ceramic) HIT-CE 35 W (Ceramic)) HIT-CE 70 W (Ceramic) HIT-CE 150 W (Ceramic) HIT-CE 250 W (Ceramic)

Characteristic values of the major lamps

ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw, tw nw, tw nw ww, nw ww ww, nw ww ww, nw ww, nw nw, tw ww ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw ww, nw

80, 70 E27 4,9005,000 8296 6,000 80, 70 E27 7,3008,100 112115 6,000 80, 70 E27 10,50012,500 168177 6,000 90, 70, 60 E40 17,00025,500 275285 6,000 90, 70, 60 E40 20,50043,000 400460 6,000 60 E40 95,000 1,0501,065 6,000 90, 80 E27 5,0006,000 85 912,000 80 E27 8,0008,500 120 12,000 90, 80 E27 12,00013,500 170 912,000 80 E40 24,500 270 12,000 80 G12 5,2005,500 8296 6,000 80 G12 13,000 168177 6,000 90, 70, 60 E40 19,00021,000 275285 6,000 80 PGJ5/G8,5/GU6,5 1,6151,700 90, 80 PGJ5/G8,5 3,0003,500 4446 9,000 90, 80 G8,5 6,3007,300 8296 9,000 90, 80 G12 3,1003,500 4446 9,000 90, 80 G12 6,4007,300 8296 9,000 80 G12 14,000 168177 6,000 90, 80 E40/G22/G12 23,00025,800 272 612,000

63 72 74 93 93 90 83 71 84 91 69 77 76 71 83 91 83 83 83 96

Chapter 4 / 27

* Lamp service life = mean service life up to 50 % failure (exception: Philips QL up to 10 % failure)

ma g n e t i c l ow- l o s s b.

el ect r on i c b al l as t

28 / Chapter 4
System Lamp power service life* in W in h
8083 172 4245 8083 172 10,000 715,000 1215,000 8296 168177 275285 4046 8995 168177 275 266270 425 8,000 8,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 10,000 7,000 12,000 12,000 6,000 6,000 75 75 72 85 79 80 89 48 51

Lamp name System power in W

Colour rendition Base Colour index Ra temperature

Luminous flux in lm (at 25C)

Max. system luLamp service life* minous efficiency in lm/W in h

90, 80 90, 80, 70 90, 80, 70 80 90, 80 90, 80 80

RX7s RX7s Fc2 RX7s RX7s RX7s Fc2

5,0006,000 11,250 20,000 3,2003,400 5,7007,000 13,50014,200 24,500

40 40

E40 E40

13,000 22,000

Metal halide lamps HIT-DE 70 W ww, nw HIT-DE 150 W ww, nw, tw HIT-DE 250 W ww, nw, tw HIT-DE-CE 35 W (Ceramic) ww HIT-DE-CE 70 W (Ceramic) ww, nw HIT-DE-CE 150 W (Ceramic) ww, nw HIT-DE-CE 250 W (Ceramic) ww High-pressure mercury vapour lamps HME 250 W ww, nw HME 400 W ww, nw High-pressure sodium vapour lamps HSE 250 W ww HSE 400 W ww HST-CRI 35 W (SDW-T) ww HST-CRI 50 W (SDW-T/-TG) ww HST-CRI 100 W (SDW-T/-TG) ww HST 250 W ww HST 400 W ww 275285 440450 4142 62 114116 275 440450 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 10,000 62 112 10,000 10,000 112 120 31 39 42 116 123

Characteristic values of the major lamps

60, 20 E40 22,00032,000 60, 20 E40 36,00054,000 80 PG12-1 1,300 80 PG12-1/GX12-1 2,3002,400 80 PG12-1/GX12-1 4,9005,000 60, 20 E40 23,00033,000 60, 20 E40 37,00056,500

* Lamp service life = mean service life up to 50 % failure (exception: Philips QL up to 10 % failure) For an extensive table of lamp data, please refer to the Technical Appendix of the ZUMTOBEL product catalogue. All data without engagement. In case of doubt, please contact the lamp manufacturer.

The Lighting Handbook

Energy efficiency of luminaires


Most of the electrical power is consumed in the lamp and its control gear. In order to clarify the power consumption of the ballast/lamp system, the European Union has adopted the energy classification system (Directive 2000/55/EU on energy efficiency requirements for ballasts for fluorescent lamps). The EEI (Energy Efficiency Index) classifies ballasts into seven categories: Class A1 A2 A3 B1 B2 C D Ballasts Dimmable electronic ballasts Reduced-loss electronic ballasts Electronic ballasts Magnetic ballasts, very low loss (low-loss ballast) Magnetic ballasts, low loss (low-loss ballast) Magnetic ballasts, moderate loss (conventional ballast) Magnetic ballasts, very high loss (conventional ballast)

Since 21 May 2002, it has been prohibited to sell class D ballasts; class C ballasts have ceased to be produced since 21 November 2005 at the latest.

Example for T26 36 W 840: EEI A1 A2 A3 B1 B2 C D 19 W (25 % dimming is equivalent to 50 % A3) 36 38 41 43 45 45 Chapter 4 / 29

The Lighting Handbook

ZUMTOBEL names

DOD

DALI

DALI only

DSI

110 V

Heavy-duty e.b. Electr. ballast

Overview of electronic ballasts

30 / Chapter 4
Luminaires can be dimmed collectively No readdressing required when replacing control gear Luminaires can be dimmed collectively Can be used with some reservations in emergency lighting installations Long service life up to 1,000,000 h Ambient temperatures up to 70C Integral over-/ undervoltage identification Long lamp service life High-quality light thanks to high-frequency operation More application options owing to DC operation Faulty lamps automatically switched off and switched on again after lamp replacement

Switchable at zero power Dimmability subsequently enabled Dimmability DALI-addressable Configurable Error and status feedback Dimming automatically blocked in DC mode Emergency lighting level adjustable for DC mode Emergency lighting-compatible DC mode Critical operating conditions

Special features

DALI-switchable Dimming function can be enabled subsequently via Litenet

Addressability: Addressability: individual individual dimming dimming Flexible grouping Flexible grouping without rewiring without rewiring Luminaire status Luminaire status feedback feedback DSI control also possible

For detailed information on ambient conditions and conditions of use, please refer to the product data sheets.

The Lighting Handbook

Power consumption 20 % to 88 %

Energy saving at normal operation Set-AC


compared with conventional ballasts 20 % to 88 % at 1 % dimming level (off)

function of dimmer setting

558 W P C A 69 W 8W

Power consumption as a

55 W 45 W 35 W 25 W 8W

8W 1%

100 % 75 % 50 % 25 % Conventional ballast Controlled by LUXMATE Dimmer setting

9:00

10:00

11:00

12:00

13:00

14:00

15:00

16:00

Power requirement of a traditional freestanding luminaire

Potential energy savings using daylight sensors and presence detectors


up to 70 % compared with constant light e.g. freestanding luminaire using SensControl

Power requirement of a freestanding luminaire using SensControl

absent

absent

cloud cover

increasing daylight

sufficient daylight

decreasing daylight

Light required in terms of ergonomics using SensControl

Set-DC 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 further potential saving of 27 % 10 0 59 53 48 43 39 35 30 28 AC-mode DC-mode potential energy saving of 52 % in (%)

Emergency lighting extra function in Tridonic PCA


Thanks to a reducible DC dimming level (Set-DC), the emergency lighting installation can be designed for reduced operation. At a luminous flux of 10 %, savings of up to 70 % are possible at DC operation.

The Lighting Handbook

22

17

12

Power (W) 10 at 230 V DC

Chapter 4 / 31

Overview of LED control gear


Cable length vs. active power for 24 V DC supply Cable lengths are limited exclusively on the assumption that a maximum voltage drop of 0.7 V is permissible. Cable cross-section/length:
Output 10 W 15 W 20 W 30 W 40 W 50 W 60 W 70 W 80 W 90 W 100 W 110 W Current 0.417 A 0.625 A 0.833 A 1.250 A 1.667 A 2.083 A 2.500 A 2.917 A 3.333 A 3.750 A 4.167 A 4.583 A Voltage 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 24 V 0.75 mm2 1 mm2 35.0 m 23.5 m 17.5 m 11.5 m 8.5 m 7.0 m 5.5 m 5.0 m 4.0 m 3.5 m 3.5 m 3.0 m 47.0 m 31.0 m 23.5 m 15.5 m 11.5 m 9.0 m 7.5 m 6.5 m 5.5 m 5.0 m 4.5 m 4.0 m 1.5 mm2 2.5 mm2 70.5 m 47.0 m 35.0 m 23.5 m 17.5 m 14.0 m 11.5 m 10.0 m 8.5 m 7.5 m 7.0 m 6.0 m 117.5 m 78.5 m 60.0 m 39.0 m 29.5 m 23.5 m 19.5 m 16.5 m 14.5 m 13.0 m 11.5 m 10.5 m

Please note: maximum voltage drop permissible = 0.7 V

RGB and dimming of LED luminaires For dimming applications, owing to partly high outputs and accordingly possible interferences with electromagnetic compatibility, other points must be taken into account: A: control unit to LED C004 amplifier The cable between control unit and amplifier (LED C004) may be up to 20 m long. Make sure that the minimum input voltage of the amplifiers control input is at least 12 V. B: LED C004 amplifier to first LED luminaire C: control unit to LED luminaire/luminaire group In order to avoid interferences with electromagnetic compatibility, the use of shielded cables for the lead between control unit and LED luminaires is recommended for cables longer than 0.5 m. Even if cables are shielded, cables longer than 15 m may lead to electromagnetic compatibility interferences in highly sensitive areas.

32 / Chapter 4

The Lighting Handbook

D: mains unit to LED luminaire/luminaire group The maximum cable length between mains unit and last

LED luminaire is specified in the table. Control gear should possibly be placed next to the luminaires.

A C + Ch 1-3 Control unit e.g. C002, K211 Ch 1 Ch 2 Ch 3 + Mains unit 12/24 V e.g. K240 + Uin + Ch 1-3 Uin Amplifier + Ch 1-3 e.g. LED C004 Ch 1 Ch 1 Ch 2 Ch 2 Ch 3 Ch 3 D

LED luminaire

Cable length for supplying current-controlled LEDs, switchable Cable lengths are limited exclusively on the assumption that a maximum voltage drop of 0.7 V is permissible. In each case, they relate to the last luminaire in a group. It is assumed that the control gear operates at max. capacity for details, please refer to the control gears technical description. A minimum voltage of 4.5 V is assumed for each LED.

Please note: use copper cables. Cables must not be laid in parallel to mains/highvoltage conductors. Cable length for supplying current-controlled LEDs, dimmable PWM The max. cable length to a groups last luminaire may be 13 m. The cable cross-section has to be > 0.25 mm2. For cables longer than 1.5 m, shielded cables have to be used.

The Lighting Handbook

Current for LED lum. 350 mA 700 mA

Cable cross-section/length 0.75 mm2 1 mm2 1.5 mm2 2.5 mm2 30.0 m 40.0 m 60.0 m 100.0 m 15.0 m 20.0 m 30.0 m 50.0 m

Chapter 4 / 33

Mains

24 V-DC

LED-mains unit On/Off Dimming

Monochrome LED luminaires, voltage controlled 24 V


LEDOS 24 V MICROS LED 24 V SYSTEMLED Deco KAVA LED 24 V

SYSTEMLED Flood

34 / Chapter 4
LEDOS 24 V SYSTEMLED Deco KAVA LED 24 V LEDOS 24 V SYSTEMLED Deco KAVA LED 24 V

Mains

24 V-DC PWM

* These luminaires must be additionally supplied with 24 V DC supply voltage!

DALI/DSI/switchDIM Mains

K210

24 V-DC

LED-mains unit

Mains

24 V-DC

SYSTEMLED Flood*

24 V-DC PWM

LED-mains unit Max. 3 POTI 100 K/Ohm linear or max. 3 x control voltage 010 V

C001

SYSTEMLED Flood*

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

Mains

24 V-DC PWM

24 V RGB LED luminaires in dynamic colours


SYSTEMLED Deco RGB KAVA LED RGB PHAOS lighting tile

DALI Mains

K211

24 V-DC

LED-mains unit

Mains

24 V-DC

SYSTEMLED Flood RGB* LEDOS 24 V RGB

24 V-DC PWM

* These luminaires must be additionally supplied with 24 V DC supply voltage!

LED-mains unit 3 POTI 100 K/Ohm linear or 3 x control voltage 010 V SYSTEMLED Deco RGB KAVA LED RGB

C001

Mains

24 V-DC

SYSTEMLED Flood RGB* LEDOS 24 V RGB

PHAOS lighting tile

LED-mains unit

24 V-DC PWM

DALI

C003 SYSTEMLED Deco RGB KAVA LED RGB PHAOS lighting tile

Mains

24 V-DC

SYSTEMLED Flood RGB* LEDOS 24 V RGB

LED-mains unit 1 POTI 100 K/Ohm linear

24 V-DC PWM

C002

Mains

24 V-DC

SYSTEMLED Flood RGB* LEDOS 24 V RGB

SYSTEMLED Deco RGB

KAVA LED RGB

PHAOS lighting tile

Application C004 PWM amplifier for controlling LED objects with higher output
LEDOS 24 V mono/RGB

LED-mains unit PWM control signal (e.g. C001, C002, C003, K210, K211)

C004

Chapter 4 / 35

The C004 amplifier is used where the luminaire output is higher than the output power of the control unit used.

SYSTEMLED Deco mono/RGB

KAVA LED mono/RGB

PHAOS lighting tile

Autom. colour sequence Colour sequence can be selected with DALI, 010 V with sequencer

24 V-DC PWM

Mains

350 mA

LED mains unit (constant current) ORILED 350 mA PANOS S 100 LED 350 mA On/Off Automatic colour sequence with sequencer, DALI 010 V Dimming

Monochrome 350 mA LED luminaires, currentcontrolled

36 / Chapter 4
ORILED 350 mA PANOS S 100 LED 350 mA PASO II RGB 350 mA PASO II RGB 350 mA

Mains

350 mA PWM

LEDOS B 350 mA

PWM control signal (e.g. C001, K210)

LED mains unit (constant current) dimmable via PWM

LEDOS B 350 mA

Mains

24 V-DC

350 mA RGB LED luminaires in dynamic colours, current-controlled

LED mains unit PWM control signal C350 PWM dimmer (e.g. C001, C002, C003, K211)

350 mA PWM

Mains

350 mA PWM

LEDOS B RGB 350 mA

Dali

K350 DALI RGB Constant-current converter

LEDOS B RGB 350 mA

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 5

Lighting and room management


LUXMATE lighting management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Easy dimming with BASIC and DIMLITE . . . . . . . . . . . . Plug & play with ZBOX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Creative solutions with EMOTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building-wide with LITENET and PROFESSIONAL . . . . . 3 4 11 12 13 14 15 16 19

LUXMATE lighting management The intelligent control system for individual rooms and throughout buildings
Function Applications LUXMATE LITENET (based on TCP/IP and DALI) Artificial light/daylight/blinds Office building with high Maximum flexibility owing to requirements in terms reconfiguration by software of flexibility, ergonomic com Can be subsequently upgraded patibility and econ. efficiency with extra functions (on demand) OPC and BACnet interfaces with other building services and BMS Optimised for TASK AREA concepts according to EN 12464 Integration of ONLITE emergency lighting system Customised control concepts LUXMATE PROFESSIONAL (based on LUXMATE bus system) Artificial light/daylight/blinds Conference rooms Interfaces to media technology Office buildings Integration of ONLITE Shopping malls emergency lighting system Museums link to BMS and central Industry maintenance LUXMATE EMOTION (based on DALI) Presence-based/daylight-based control Shops Timer Health & Care Special luminaires: RGB, Tempura Wellness ACTIVE LIGHT lighting concepts Control rooms Flexibility of individual Offices addressing/grouping In the home ZBOX Lighting scenes RGB colour control Nightlogic Webtool

The Lighting Handbook

LUXMATE BASIC/DIMLITE (based on DSI/DALI) Daylight-based In the home Infrared remote control unit Small offices & Standard switch components surgeries No addressing, group dimming Commercial premises Zero-power switching and dimming

BASIC

ZBOX

EMOTION

LITENET

PROFESSIONAL

Hotels Private dwellings Shops

Chapter 5 / 3

LUXMATE control unit

Lamp control gear (electronic ballast, transformer, ...)

Two steps to create your lighting solution

Dimming with LUXMATE BASIC/DIMLITE

4 / Chapter 5
DALI DSI DALI-T DSI-T* DALI-TD DSI-TD* DALI-TLC DSI-TLC DIMLITE 4ch** (4-channel) DIMLITE 2CH** (2-channel)
All modules available for installation in luminaire or recess into ceiling * also available as housing for installation in switch cabinet ** only available as housing for installation in switch cabinet

1. select appropriate lamp control gear

Lamps GLS lamps PAR lamps HV halogen incandescent lamps LV halogen incandescent lamps Fluorescent lamps LED High-pressure discharge lamps

Dimming range 0100 % 0100 % 0100 % 0100 % 1100 % 0100 % cannot be dimmed

All control gear with DALI/DSI control input Phase dimmer: 50010005000 VA Phase dimmer: 50010005000 VA Phase dimmer: 50010005000 VA electronic dimmable transformer: 105 VA + 150 VA electronic dimmable ballast electronic dimmable LED converter 1 ch./3 ch. PCI-FOX electronic ballast

2. select control funtion required

Function Dimming, 1 channel Dimming, 1 channel, with 1 light-level memory Daylight-based dimming, 2 channels 2 or 4-channel multifunction

Control Module name: momentary-action switch, presence detector momentary-action switch momentary-action switch, light sensor momentary-action switch Circle, light sensor, presence detector, IR remote control unit

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook


Lamp control gear Lamps

User control units

Control Units

L N PE DSI electronic ballast, max. 25 DALI electronic ballast, max. 25* Fluorescent lamps T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL L N D1 PCA D2 12 11 10 9

230/240 V 50/60 Hz

Conventional double momentary-action light switch On/Off Dimming

Control line e.g. NYM 2 x 1.5 mm2, max. length 100 m

Conventional momentaryaction light switch Preset/Dia DSI phase dimmer, max. 25 DALI phase dimmer, max. 25* D1 D2
APD

Momentary-action switch control L module with input for preset light level N D1 T T D2 DSI-TD Preset/Dia

or
L' N N L

DALI-TD

L L N PE T

Alternative: Connect terminals T and T together with a jumper if a single momentary-action switch is used.

Programming instructions for preset light level (Dia): Set brightness level required using momentary-action switch Press the Preset/Dia switch for at least 5 seconds

or
DSI transformer, max. 25 DALI transformer, max. 25* max. 2 m D1 D2
TE

Incandescent lamps/ HV halogen incandescent lamps max. 300 VA

LUXMATE BASIC DSI-TD or DALI-TD

phase dimmed phase neutral protective earth momentary-action switch input control line earth AC voltage

* available on request

LV halogen incandescent lamps max. 105/150 VA

Arguments for your customers

Dimming using conventional momentary-action light switches and with dimming-level memory

Chapter 5 / 5

Absolutely flicker-free dimming Simple to operate using conventional momentary-action light switches throughout Hence ensures standardised design of light switches and sockets Any number of momentary-action light switches can be connected in parallel

Dimming range: 1 to 100 % light Lamps can be started at any dimming level Suitable for all major lamp types Easy to install Insensitive to mains fluctuations and interference Components can be delivered separately or pre-fitted in the luminaire Dimming-level memory

Daylight-based control with DIMLITE and DALI/DSI-TLC


Applications Single and team offices Areas near windows in shopping centres Classrooms Industrial bays Gym halls Warehouses

0%

50 %

500 lx artificial light daylight

Arguments for your customers Dims the lighting from 1001 %, based exactly on the daylight available Accurate window-light sensor rather than error-prone roomlight sensor Energy savings of up to 75 % Brightness level can be changed at any time using momentary-action dimmer switches Economically priced short pay-back period Long lamp service life Option to connect presence detector
The Lighting Handbook

6 / Chapter 5

ED-EYE/LSD sensor positioning

Installed in luminaire 2 groups 4 groups DALI-TLC/DSI-TLC

Switch cabinet DIMLITE 2ch DIMLITE 4ch

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 5 / 7

DIMLITE Multifunctional lighting control


Arguments for your customers Compact lighting control unit for 2/4 luminaire groups DALI and DSI outputs automatic identification Reducing stand-by loss: automatic power disconnection of lighting actuators via integrated relay Up to 3 lighting scenes, one of them with daylight-based control (depending on additional devices) Modular range of functions, to be individually combined: daylight-based control lighting scene module presence detectors/movement sensors group module infrared remote control unit Circle comfort control unit AUTO setup: automatic initialisation, no addressing required Design notes DIMLITE 2ch two-channel unit and DIMLITE 4ch four-channel unit are identical except for the number of output channels and corresponding key inputs. Maximum cable length for all control lines (Control-IN, DSI and DALI): max. 300 m each at 1.5 mm. The DIMLITE outputs are DSI or DALI broadcast no addressing is required during commissioning. Groups are assigned by wiring the lighting actuators accordingly. Maximum of 25 DALI units (25 DALI loads) or 50 DSI units per output channel. Only Zumtobel ED units may be connected to Control-IN. Maximum of 8 ED units at Control IN (exception: max. 1 light sensor). Up to 3 lighting scenes, depending on the control unit used; each control unit will always call up the same scene 1, 2, 3 or OFF. The functions of the ED-SDED2 ED unit may be selected using the integrated rotary switch: either scene module (1, 2, 3, OFF) or group module (dimming of Group 1, 2, 3, 4). Conventional 230 V momentary-action switches can be connected to the momentary-action switch inputs. PIR input to connect a conventional movement sensor. Relay for mains cut-off: 16 A resistive load; in case of higher loads or capacitive/inductive loads, an external power contactor is recommended.

8 / Chapter 5

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

DIMLITE

L 230 V AC N PE ED-Eye ED-Sens IRlight sensor (PD+IR) TOUCH Multi-sensor DALI/DSI HFG (1 DALI load)
PCA

User control units

Control units

Lamp control gear

Lamps

ED-IR infrared receiver L N DA DA DALI/DSI HFG (1 DALI load)


PCA

ED-SDED2 ED-SDED2 Circle Cxx group lighting control point module scene module comf. contr. unit T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL fluorescent lamps T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL fluorescent lamps

Load contactor (optional)

Multifunctional lighting control

max. 300 m at 1.5 mm max. 8 ED units L N DA DA DALI/DSI HFG (1 DALI load)


PCA

optional mains isolation facility

Relay L N DA DA DALI/DSI HFG (1 DALI load)


PCA

max. 300 m at 1.5 mm max. 25 DALI or 50 DSI per channel T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL fluorescent lamps T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL fluorescent lamps

Control IN

Channels 3 + 4 only with DIMLITE 4 ch L N DA DA

Presence detector L N DA DA

EMOTION-1RUK (10 DALI loads) e.g.: incandescent lamps DA K DA K TE one4all (1 DALI load) e.g.: incandescent lamps

Chapter 5 / 9

Lighting scene/ autom. daylight-based control

All groups

Group 1

Group 2 Group 3

Group 4

User control units

Control units

Lamp control gear

Lamps

Daylight-based control for small rooms

LUXMATE BASIC Daylight DSI-TLC or DALI-TLC

10 / Chapter 5
Fluorescent lamps T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL 12 11 10 9 Group II
PCA

L 230/240 V 50/60 Hz N PE

LSD light sensor

Light-sensor line e.g. NYM 2 x 1.5 mm2, max. length 100 m

Fluorescent lamps T26/T16 DSI electronic ballast, max. 25/group I, II TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL DALI electronic ballast, max. 25 /group I, II 12 L 11 N D1 10 PCA D2 9 Group I

Conventional double momentary-action light switch

G I G II

L T1 T3 PD

Daylight-based control unit installed in luminaire/recessed into ceiling N Se2Se1 T2 D2 D1 T4 D2 D1 DSI-TLC in

DALI-TLC

On/Off Dimming

Motion sensor/ Presence detector

or

DSI electronic ballast, max. 25/group I, II DALI electronic ballast, max. 25/group I, II

L N PE T PD Se D

phase neutral protective earth momentary-action switch input presence detector input light sensor input control line earth AC voltage

Control line e.g. NYM 2 x 1.5 mm 2 max. length 100 m

L N D1 D2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook


Lamp control gear
max. length of DALI line 2 x 0.50 mm max. 116 m max. 174 m max. 232 m max. 300 m 2 x 0.75 mm 2 x 1.00 mm 2 x 1.50 mm >

User control units

Lamps

L Mains 230/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz N PE L N DALI bus power supply DA DA

LUXMATE BASIC Circle Kit

DA DA

DA DA

DALI-CSS DALI-CSW

DALI-based lighting control system for individual rooms

L N PE DA

phase neutral protective earth DALI control line earth AC voltage

optionally several control points

supply via DALI control line (3 DALI loads)

L DALI electronic ballast N PE PCA DA DA L DALI phase dimmer N PE DA APD DA L DALI transformer N PE DA TE DA * max. 64 DALI-compatible lamp control gear

Arguments for your customers

Chapter 5 / 11

Three lighting scenes can be called up using intuitive control unit Two luminaire groups can be individually dimmed Control of a max. of 64 DALI-controllable luminaires Luminaires addressed via control unit

Several control units can be used in parallel Easy installation Personal lighting scenes can be stored

ZBOX plug&play system for hotel rooms, private dwellings and shops
Plug&Play pre-addressed and preprogrammed plug-in connectors local stand-alone or networked system web tool for fine-adjustment, no licence required FAQs What is the minimum load to be applied to the universal dimmer? 20 W How many luminaires may be connected to a ZBOX Controller? Max. of 300 W/channel or 10 DALI loads; total maximum output power per ZBOX: 16 A. Depending on the outputs of the luminaires used, a varying number of electronic ballasts may be used for an automatic circuit-breaker! What happens at the output side during a short circuit? The dimming module has been fitted with overload protection for lighting loads, extremely high inductive or capacitive loads may destroy the dimmer. The relay contact and the Controller have no overload protection; the electrician must ensure proper selectivity of the installation. direct connection via TCP-IP transparency of costs can be upgraded 4 control points included DALI Broadcast (no addressing of loads, except for RGB/W)

Does one always have to use a CIRCLE control unit? Via the SDED2 input module, conventional momentaryaction switches can be integrated. How can the ZBOX be upgraded? All LUXMATE bus units can be connected to the ZBOX Controller. It is also possible to network several Controllers. In this case, the plug&play function may not work. It makes sense to let an engineer do the commissioning. Can the ZBOX also be used for other applications? For other applications such as nursing homes, private dwellings or ordinary shops, the function and control concept can be adjusted via the ZBOX. WEBTOOL.
The Lighting Handbook

12 / Chapter 5

The Lighting Handbook


Left bed/reading Group 2 Group 1 Right bed/reading Window

Bathroom Mirror

Ceiling

Wellness**

Group 9 Blinds/ curtain

ZBOX wiring scheme

Group 8

Group 7

** Luminaire pre-addressed, 4 channels No phase dimmer

Ceiling Group 3

Entrance area

Ceiling

Group 5

Wall/table Group 4

optionally

Group 6

Chapter 5 / 13

* Every luminaire optionally connected to phase dimmer, DALI and/or relay

LUXMATE EMOTION Lighting control system


Operation/supply
L N PE Mains 230/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz

EMOTION Touch/EMOTION Touch C L N

MomentaryDouble Presence momentary- action or action switch standard switch detector

COM T 1 T 2 COM T 3 DA DA DA DA DALI 1 DALI 2 EKXP installation box (please order separately)

COM T 4

DA DA EMOTION-BVS2* EMOTION-EYE (2 DALI loads) DA DA EMOTION-BV2*

max. 0.25 m COM T 1 T 2 T 3 T 4

DA DA

EMOTION-SDED2 (2 DALI loads) DA DA

DA DA Line 1: DALI control line e.g. NYM 2 x 1.5 mm 2 max. length 300 m max. 64 users (addresses) 99 DALI loads, actuators, inputs Line 2: DALI control line e.g. NYM 2 x 1.5 mm 2 max. length 300 m max. 64 users (addresses) 99 DALI loads, actuators, inputs

EMOTION-SENS (4 DALI loads)

Cable lengths of DALI control line


Conductor cross-sections DALI control line 2 2 2 2 x x x x 0.50 0.75 mm 2 1.00 mm 2 1.50 mm 2 mm 2
IR-TOUCH

Cable length 116 174 232 300 m m m m

Switching lamps using LUXMATE EMOTION


Lamp type A, PAR, QT T16/T26 with low-loss ballast (parallel p.f. corrected) TC with low-loss ballast (parallel p.f. corrected) T16/T26/TC with electr. ballast LV with transformer HIT, SDW-T, HS, HM Safe installed load EMOTION-1RUK 500 W 250 W 250 W 30A for 0.5 s max. 30A for 0.5 s max. EMOTION-4RUKS 4 x 2,000 W 4 x 920 W 4 x 800 W 4 x 10A 4 x 10A 4 x 800 W

14 / Chapter 5

Lighting/emergency lighting
L N DA DA DALI electronic ballast one4all (1 DALI load) K1 K 1' K2 K 2' K3 K 3' K4 K 4' K K' EMOTION-1RUK (10 DALI loads) EMOTION-CSX (3 DALI loads) L N DA DA L' N EMOTION-APD (1 DALI load) max. 2 m TE one4all (1 DALI load) R G B DALI-LED converter (1 DALI load) LV halogen incandescent lamps Incandescent lamps/ HV halogen incandescent lamps e.g. incandescent lamps 12 11 10 9 Fluorescent lamps T26/T16 TC-L/TC-DEL/TC-TEL

L N DA DA EMOTION-4RUKS (1 DALI load)

DA DA

DA DA

L N DA DA

L N DA DA

LED luminaires

L N DA DA EMOTION-ANAS (1 DALI load) L N DA DA

L' N

0/110 V units e.g. STARFLEX bre optics (1 DALI load)

DALI-2DSI (1 DALI load)

D1 D2 D1 D2

25 DSI luminaires 25 DSI luminaires

L N DA DA Locally supplied emergency luminaire LOCAL CHECK NT1 NT3 LDE DO (2 DALI loads) L N DA DA Escape-sign luminaire LOCAL CHECK (1 DALI load)

Chapter 5 / 15

LUXMATE LITENET for any size of building


LITENET flexis N2 with server functions PC with LITENET insite management software

Ethernet (TCP/IP)

Netlink

Netlink Daylight sensor

3 x 64 DALI Luminaires

Bus

Blinds

Control points

LITENET economy up to 500 output addresses no server required


LITENET flexis N3 with server functions

LITENET flexisN2 without rotating parts (wear-free) optional LITENET incontrol operating software
PC with LITENET insite management software

Ethernet (TCP/IP)

Netlink

Netlink Daylight sensor

3 x 64 DALI Luminaires

Bus

Blinds

Control points

LITENET compact up to 2,000 output addresses no server required LITENET flexis N3 in 19" rack

fail-safe thanks to RAID1 optional LITENET incontrol operating software optional BACnet and OPC interfaces

PC with LITENET insite management software LITENET flexis N1 LITENET flexis N1 LITENET flexis N1

Ethernet ( TCP/IP)

Netlink

Netlink

Daylight sensor

3 x 64 DALI Luminaires Blinds Control points Standard L ITENET server

16 / Chapter 5

The Lighting Handbook

LITENET flexible LITENET server extremely up to 10,000 output addresses fail-safe thanks to RAID1 optional LITENET incontrol (or more upon request) operating software can be cascaded as required LITENET flexis N1 installed in optional BACnet and OPC switch cabinet interfaces

DALI a must for modern office buildings


Benefits of DALI installation: Individual addressing: As each luminaire can be addressed individually, the highest flexibility requirements can be met and installation faults can be avoided. Luminaires are grouped and assigned to control units subsequently, via the easy to use LITENET-insite software. Status feedback from each individual luminaire: Detailed knowledge about the installations state enable the operator to optimise operation and maintenance. Moreover, current alarms can be displayed by screen, printer, e-mail or text message. Zero-power switching: Both installation effort and space required in the switch cabinet are reduced, as a switched phase is not required for each luminaire. ZUMTOBEL Dimming on Demand (DOD) makes DALI available at a special price Previously, users could only choose between switchable luminaires with electronic ballast or more expensive luminaires based on DALI. With a switchable DALI luminaire model, ZUMTOBEL is now offering a real innovation providing cost benefits at all stages of a project from design through to actual operation of a building.
Operation Purchase Implementation Project stages Project planning Planning Design Costs of modification
Modification costs with conventional luminaires Modification costs with DOD luminaires

The Lighting Handbook

The models of this switchable luminaire originally supplied already boast all the above-mentioned benefits. And if dimming should be required at a later point in time for instance for convenient control of scenes or economically efficient daylight-based control, the dimming function can be purchased at any time via a software upgrade, without any additional installation effort.

Chapter 5 / 17

LUXMATE PROFESSIONAL (selection)


Commissioning/user control units
LM-CG/ LM-PFC LM-EG Installation-specic Single-room LM-MPO operation solution LM-CPA/CPO LM-XPO Single-/ Multi-room solution IRED LM-IRB

LM-CS(X) control point IRS B1, B2, L, N


24VDC 24VAC

B 1 , B 2 , L, N B 1 , B 2 , L, N

RS-232 link to AV system ASCI plain text protocol B1, B2 LM-SI03 L, N

B1, B2 L, N
230 VAC

B1, B2

LM-SDED LM-SWED LM-RFR

LUXMATE Bus Mains DSI- or DALI control line Sensor cable For dimming and switching individual luminaire groups

EnOcean Function switch without battery

Room management/central control/automation


Screen B1, B2 B1, B2 K1 LM-2LSE Blinds Motor 1 B1, B2 Blinds Motor 2 LM-2JSM

LM-RV Partition switch

L, N

L, N

L, N

B1, B2 LM-2FSE
L, N

B1, B2 LM-ZSM L, N Motor 2 Timer control

B1, B2 LM-iZSQ L, N Sequence automation

Motor 1

Window

Window LM-BVS35

B1, B2

L, N

18 / Chapter 5

Lighting management
LM-2RUK L, N B1, B2 K', K L, N Electronic/conventional ballast for discharge lamps HIT/HST/HME lamps

Switching
LM-DSI L, N B1, B2 up to 10 DSI electronic ballasts D1, D2 D1, D2 L, N

Fluorescent lamps

DSI dimming
up to 10 DSI electronic ballasts up to 10 DALI electronic ballasts LM-2TL LM 2TL DALI L, N B1, B2 L, N D1, D2 D1, D2 D1, D2 Fluorescent lamps LSD option to connect a daylight sensor to the LM-STL or LM-2TL/DALI up to 10 DSI electronic ballasts up to 10 DALI electronic ballasts D1, D2 L, N

Daylight-based dimming (DSI or DALI)


DA, DA PCA LM-DALI L, N B1, B2 up to 64 ballasts in 16 groups DA, DA DA, DA TE DA, DA LED converter LED luminaires LV halogen incandescent lamps DA, DA APD Fluorescent lamps Incandescent lamps/ HV halogen incandescent lamps

DALI dimming
ONLITE interface, emergency lighting

LM-DALIS

SB 64 Local check repeater

SB 128 local check CTP

locally supplied LOCAL CHECK emergency luminaire LOCAL CHECK escape-sign luminaire

ONLITE interface for emergency lighting/local supply

Chapter 5 / 19

Chapter 6

Quickplan calculating the n of lum. required


Efficiency method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS HF/HG PSP+ 175/200/250 (partly PSP+). . . . . PANOS LF/LG TC-DEL 175/200/250 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS LG/LG PSP+ M LG TC-TEL 250 . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS S HIT-CE 150/200/250 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS L and H 200/250 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS Q Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANOS Q High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VAERO-S ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OREA GZ-ID T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHT FIELDS surface-mounted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHT FIELDS recessed T16 M625 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LIGHT FIELDS A-ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MELLOW LIGHT IV Microprismatic (recessed) . . . . . . . . MELLOW LIGHT IV Microprismatic (surf.-mounted) . . . . MELLOW LIGHT IV Louvre (surf.-mounted/recessed) . MELLOW LIGHT IV Grid-mesh controller (surf.-moun./rec.) SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID T16 EVG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIREL FEC2 T16 M600. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIREL FEC2 T16 M625. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES BWS T16 (surf.-mounted/rec) . . MIRAL FAC T16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIRAL FAC-ID T16 1-lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MIRAL FAC-ID T16 2-lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II MD-ID T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II MD-D T16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II MC-ID T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II P-ID T16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLARIS II P-D T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2LIGHT E1-Mini/TC-TELI/HIT and E3 TC-L . . . . . . . . . . RTX II C or D. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RTX II C-ID T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Free-standing uplights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON(-I) + RW T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON(-I) + RW T16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON-IP louvre T16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON D-ML-B and ML-C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON D-ID and I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TECTON D-PL (Pool-Light). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA I 250 W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA I 400 W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA D RKF/RKID 32/42/57/85 W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA D HIT 70/150 W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA D 250 W QT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA A-B HIT/HST 250 W . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA A-B HIT/HST 400 W. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA A-N HME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA A-B, A-T, A-ASY HST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COPA A-ASY HIT/HST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PERLUCE D/O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RAIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CHIARO FTR390/FTR680 T16-R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCUBA T26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLEAN Classic C-O/R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLEAN Advanced A-C/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CLEAN Supreme S-C/R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58

Efficiency method
The Quickplan graphs have been calculated using the efficiency method. The following formulae can be used to give an approximate figure for the mean illuminance and the number of luminaires required. Em = n z L MF A
B

n=

Em A z L MF

Em = mean illuminance z = number of lamps per luminaire L = luminous flux of the lamp* B = utilization factor (= LB R ) LB = luminaire efficiency R = room utilization factor

n = number of luminaires MF = maintenance factor A = floor area

Standard UGR values and maintained luminance levels for luminance limit angle (e.g. 65 or 75) all around the luminaire Correction factors for dark rooms and different ceiling heights (no. of luminaires x factor) Maintenance factor uses an assumed value (graphs calculated using MF = 0.8) Uniformity: max. luminaire spacing to achieve a uniformity greater than or equal to 0.7
Please note: with maximum spacing between luminaires, the illuminance level required is usually not achieved. * Luminaire efficiency generally relates to laboratory measurements at an ambient temperature of 25 C. For designing, it is therefore required to use the rated luminous flux levels of lamps at 25 C in the calculation programmes and/or when applying the efficiency method. Today, these values are usually calculated on a computer-aided basis, by accessing luminaire databases.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 6 / 3

500 lx 300 lx

PANOS HF/HG PSP+175/200/250 (partly PSP+)


2/13 W TC-DEL (175) 2/13 W PSP+ (175)

4 / Chapter 6 Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3
2/26 W (200) 2/26 W PSP+ (200) 2/26 W TC-DEL (250) 2/26 W PSP+ (250)

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

PANOS HF/HG 2/13 W PSP+ (175) PANOS HF/HG 2/26 W (200) PANOS HF/HG 2/26 W PSP+ (200) PANOS HF/HG 2/26 W PSP+ (250) PANOS HF/HG 2/13 W TC-DEL (175) PANOS HF/HG 2/26 W TC-DEL (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 / *75 < 19 < 19 *200 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 1000 cd/m2 < 22 < 19 1000 cd/m2 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 22 < 19 1000 cd/m2 200 cd/m2 < 19 < 16

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 3 years

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 180 200

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

Uniformity Axial spacing up to 2.8 m (2/26 200), 2.9 m (2/13, 2/26 PSP+ 250) 3.2 m (2/13 PSP+, 2/26)

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

PANOS LF/LG TC-DEL 175/200/250

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

PANOS LF/LG 2/13 W TC-DEL (175) PANOS LF/LG 2/18 W TC-DEL (200) PANOS LF/LG 2/26 W TC-DEL (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 75 < 22 < 22 < 200 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 200 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22

2/13 W (175)

2/18 W (200)

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 3 years

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10


2/26 W (250)

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6

Uniformity
200 Axial spacing up to 3.7 m (2/18 W), up to 4 m (2/13 W, 2/26 W), up to 4.4 m (2/32 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

Chapter 6 / 5

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
LG 2/32 W LG 2/32 W PSP+ M LG 2/32 W

PANOS LG/LG PSP+ M LG TC-TEL 250


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

6 / Chapter 6
18 12 6

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

PANOS LG 2/32 W TC-TEL (250) PANOS LG 2/32 W PSP+ TC-TEL (250) PANOS M LG 2/32 W TC-TEL (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 28 < 25 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 25 < 25 < 25 < 25 < 1000 cd/m 2

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 4.7

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15
1/70 W (150) FL 1/70 W (200) FL 1/70 W (250)

PANOS S HIT-CE 150/200/250


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

25 12 9 6 3

PANOS S 1/70 W HIT-CE (150) FL G8.5 PANOS S 1/70 W HIT-CE (200) FL G12 PANOS S 1/70 W HIT-DE (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 28 < 28

20

15

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.77 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
160 180 200 Axial spacing up to 1.7 m, and 1/70 W 250 up to 4 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

Chapter 6 / 7

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
60 50 40 30 20 10

PANOS L and H 200/250


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area

60

8 / Chapter 6
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

PANOS LG 2/18 W (200) PANOS LG PSP+1/32 W (200) PANOS HG 2/26 W (250) PANOS HG 1/42 W PSP+ (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 / *75 *< 200 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22 *< 200 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22 < 200 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 200 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19

40

LG 2/18 W (200)

LG 1/32 W PSP+ (200)

30

HG 2/26 W (250) HG 1/42 W PSP+ (250)

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 3 years

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 3.9 m for LG, and 2.9 m for HG

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
60 50 40 30 20 10 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

PANOS Q Low
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

PANOS Q LF 1/32 W TC-TELI (190) PANOS Q LG 1/32 W TC-TELI (190) PANOS Q LM 1/32 W TC-TELI (190) PANOS Q LL 1/32 W TC-TELI (190)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 25 < 28 < 25 < 25 < 25 < 28 < 25

LL 1/32 W TC-TELI (190)

40

LM 1/32 W TC-TELI (190)

30

LF + LG 1/32 W TC-TELI (190)

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.76 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 5.8 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 9

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6

PANOS Q High
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area

60

10 / Chapter 6
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

PANOS Q HG 2/18 W TC-TELI (250) PANOS Q HG 2/26 W TC-TELI (250) PANOS Q HG 2/32 W TC-TELI (250) PANOS Q HF 2/42 W TC-TELI (250)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 19 < 16 < 19 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 22 < 19

40

HG 2/18 W TC-TELI (250)

HG 2/26 W TC-TELI (250)

30

HG 2/32 W TC-TELI (250)

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

HF 2/42 W TC-TELI (250)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.76 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 3.4 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
2/28 W

VAERO-S ID
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

40 18
2/35 W 2/54 W 2/49 W

VAERO-S ID 2/28 W SR ASI1000 VAERO-S ID 2/35 W SR ASI1000 VAERO-S ID 2/49 W SR ASI1000 VAERO-S ID 2/54 W SR ASI1000 VAERO-S ID 2/80 W SR ASI1000

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 55 65 <13 <13 < 1500 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2 <13 <13 < 1500 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2 <13 <13 < 1500 cd/m2 < 1500 cd/m2 <13 <13 <13 <13

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

20
2/80 W

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0,77 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 5.6 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 11

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
18
2/49 W

OREA GZ-ID T16


15 12
2/54 W 2/80 W

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

12 / Chapter 6 Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3 9 6 3

Ceiling height: 3 m

25

OREA GZ-ID 2/54 W T16 OREA GZ-ID 2/49 W T16 OREA GZ-ID 2/80 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. <13 <13 <13 <13 <13 <13

20

15

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.75 4000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 5.6 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
4/14 W

LIGHT FIELDS surface-mounted


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m UGR_axial UGR_transv.

50

L-FIELDS A 2/28 W L-FIELDS A 2/35 W L-FIELDS A 4/14 W

< 16 < 16 < 16

< 16 < 16 < 16

65 < 1000 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2

40 18 12 6

30
2/28 W 2/35 W

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.77 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up to


180 200 3.7 m (2/28 W, 2/35 W), axial spacing up to 3.4 m (2/24 W, 4/14 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 13

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
2/24 W

LIGHT FIELDS recessed T16 M625


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

14 / Chapter 6
24 18 12 6
4/14 W 2/28 W 2/35 W

Ceiling height: 3 m UGR_axial UGR_transv.

65

50

L-FIELD 2/24 W T16 L-FIELD 2/28 W T16 L-FIELD 2/35 W T16 L-FIELD 4/14 W T16

< 16 < 16 < 16 < 16

< 16 < 16 < 16 < 16

< 1000 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.77 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up to


180 200 3.7 m (2/28 W, 2/35 W), axial spacing up to 3.4 m (4/14 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18
4/24 W 2/54 W

LIGHT FIELDS A-ID


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

L-FIELDS A-ID 2/49 W L-FIELDS A-ID 2/54 W L-FIELDS A-ID 4/24 W

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 <13 <13 < 1000 cd/m2 <13 <13 < 1000 cd/m2 <13 <13 < 1000 cd/m2

40

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

20
2/49 W

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.75 4000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up to


180 200 3.7 m (2/49 W, 2/54 W), axial spacing up to 3.1 m (4/24 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 15

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18
EM 2/35 W T16

MELLOW LIGHT IV Microprismatic (recessed)


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

16 / Chapter 6
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

40

ML4 B EM 1/55 W TCL M600 ML4 B EM 1/55 W TC-L M625 ML4 A EM 2/35 W T16 M625 ML4 A EM 2/49 W T16 M600 ML4 A EM 2/49 W T16 M625

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 22

EM 1/55 W TC-L 625

30 12 6

EM 1/55 W TC-L 600

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

EM 2/49 W T16

10

Clean medium-sized room (T16) Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.76 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
160 180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 5.4 m (1/55 W) or 4.7 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

Floor area m2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6

MELLOW LIGHT IV Microprismatic (surface-mounted)


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

40
AM 1/54 W T16

ML4 A AM 1/54 W T16 ML4 B AM 2/24 W T16 ML4 B AM 2/24 W + 2/24 W T16 ML4 B AM 2/40 W TC-L ML4 A AM 2/49 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 19 < 16 < 22 < 16 < 25 < 19 < 25 < 19 < 22 < 19

AM 2/24 W T16

height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

AM 2/40 W TC-L

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

AM 2/49 W T16

AM 2/24 W + 2/24 W T16

10

Clean medium-sized room (T16) Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.76 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity Max. axial spacing up to


180 200 6.8 m (2/24 W + 2/24 W, 2/40 W), 5.9 m (2/24 W), 4.5 m (1/54 W, 2/49 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 17

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
EC 2/24 W T16

MELLOW LIGHT IV Louvre (surface-mounted/recessed)


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

18 / Chapter 6
24
EC 1/55 W TC-L

Ceiling height: 3 m

50 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

40 18
EC 2/54 W T16

ML IV A AC 2/35 W T16 ML IV A AC 2/49 W T16 ML IV A AC 2/54 W T16 ML IV B EC 1/55 W TC-L M625 ML IV B EC 2/24 W T16 M625 ML IV A EC 2/54 W T16 M625

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m2 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m2 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 16 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 16 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2

over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

AC 2/35 W T16

20

AC 2/49 W T16

AC 2/54 W T16

10

Clean medium-sized room (T16) Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.8 6000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4 m, axial spacing up to 4.7 m (2/24 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6

MELLOW LIGHT IV Grid-mesh controller


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area

60

(surface-mounted/recessed)

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

EB 2/24 W T16

40

ML IV A AB 2/35 W T16 ML IV A AB 2/49 W T16 ML IV A AB 2/54 W T16 ML IV B EB 1/55 W TC-L M625 ML IV B EB 2/24 W T16 M625 ML IV B EB 2/54 W T16 M625

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 19 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 19 < 22 < 22

EB 1/55 W TC-L

AB 2/35 W T16

AB 2/54 W T16

height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

EB 2/54 W T16

AB 2/49 W T16

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room (T16) Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.8 6000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing, axial spacing up to 5.4 m/4.7 m (2/54 W EB)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 19

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36
1/35 W

SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID T16 Electronic ballast


30 24
1/54 W 2/28 W 2/35 W 2/54 W

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

20 / Chapter 6 Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3 18 12 6

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

40

SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID 1/35 W T16 SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID 1/54 W T16 SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID 2/28 W T16 SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID 2/35 W T16 SPHEROS D-ID/C-ID 2/54 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 <13 <13 < 500 cd/m 2 <16 <13 < 1000 cd/m2 <16 <13 < 1000 cd/m2 <16 <13 < 1000 cd/m2 <16 <16 < 1000 cd/m2

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.77 4000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.8 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36
1/28 W

MIREL FEC2 T16 M600


30
1/35 W

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50 24 18 12 6 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

40
1/54 W 4/14 W 2/28 W

MIREL FEC2 1/28 W T16 M600 MIREL FEC2 1/35 W T16 M600 MIREL FEC2 1/54 W T16 M600 MIREL FEC2 2/28 W T16 M600 MIREL FEC2 B 4/14 W T16 M600

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2

Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area


over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up


180 200 to 4.8 m (4/14 W) or 4.4 m (1/28 W, 1/35 W, 1/54 W, 2/28 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 21

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36
1/28 W

MIREL FEC2 T16 M625


30
1/35 W 1/54 W 4/14 W 2/28 W

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

22 / Chapter 6 Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3 24 18 12 6

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

40

MIREL FEC2 1/28 W T16 M625 MIREL FEC2 1/35 W T16 M625 MIREL FEC2 1/54 W T16 M625 MIREL FEC2 2/28 W T16 M625 MIREL FEC2 B 4/14 W T16 M625

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up


180 200 to 4.8 m (4/14 W) or 4,4 m (1/28 W, 1/35 W, 1/54 W, 2/28 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15
1/80 W

MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES BWS T16

30

(surface-mounted/recessed)
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.2 1.3

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

25 12 9
2/80 W

MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES-BWS 1/80 W T16 MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES-BWS 2/80 W T16 MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES-BWS 3/80 W T16 MIRAL/MIREL RAS/RES-BWS 4/80 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 16 < 19 < 19 < 22 < 16 < 19 < 19 < 22

20

15 6
3/80 W 4/80 W

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.80 2000 h 1 year 1 year

10 3

Uniformity
Continuous row spacing up to 3.9 m 180 200

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 23

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
1/28 W

MIRAL FAC T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

24 / Chapter 6
24
1/49 W

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

MIRAL FAC 1/28 W T16 MIRAL FAC 1/49 W T16 MIRAL FAC 2/54 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 22 < 22 < 1000 cd/m2

40 18 12 6

30
2/54 W

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 4.5 m (1/49 W) or 3.9 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36
1/28 W

MIRAL FAC-ID T16 1-lamp


30 24 18 12 6

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50
1/35 W 1/49 W 1/54 W

MIRAL FAC-ID 1/28 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 1/35 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 1/49 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 1/54 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 16 < 16 < 200 cd/m2 < 16 < 16 < 200 cd/m2 < 16 < 16 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2

Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area


height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 3.5 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 25

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

MIRAL FAC-ID T16 2-lamp


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

26 / Chapter 6
2/28 W 2/35 W 2/49 W 2/54 W

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

MIRAL FAC-ID 2/28 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 2/35 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 2/49 W T16 MIRAL FAC-ID 2/54 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 500 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 3.5 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
1/35 W

CLARIS II MD-ID T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50 24 18 12 6

CLARIS II MD-ID 1/35 W T16 CLARIS II MD-ID 1/54 W T16 CLARIS II MD-ID 2/35 W T16 CLARIS II MD-ID 2/54 W T16

40
1/54 W

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 500 cd/m 2 < 13 < 13 < 500 cd/m 2 < 16 < 13 < 13 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2

30
2/35 W 2/54 W

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.0 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 27

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

CLARIS II MD-D T16

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

28 / Chapter 6
1/28 W

Ceiling height: 3 m

CLARIS II MD-D 1/28 W T16 CLARIS II MD-D 1/49 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 19 < 19 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 1000 cd/m2

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.79 4000 h 1 year 2 years

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10


1/49 W

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6

Uniformity
Continuous row spacing up to 4.2 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

200

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
1/35 W

CLARIS II MC-ID T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50 24
1/54 W

CLARIS II MC-ID 1/35 W T16 CLARIS II MC-ID 1/54 W T16 CLARIS II MC-ID 2/35 W T16 CLARIS II MC-ID 2/54 W T16

40 18
2/35 W 2/54 W

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1500 cd/m2 < 13 < 13 < 16 < 16 < 13 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 16

height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 5.4 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 29

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
1/54 W 1/49 W

CLARIS II P-ID T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

30 / Chapter 6
1/35 W

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

CLARIS II P-ID 1/35 W T16 CLARIS II P-ID 1/54 W T16 CLARIS II P-ID 1/49 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 19 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2

40 18 12 6

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 5.3 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

CLARIS II P-D T16

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

CLARIS II P-D 1/28 W T16 CLARIS II P-D 1/49 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 22 < 22 1000 cd/m2 < 25 < 25 1000 cd/m2

1/28 W

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.79 4000 h 1 year 2 years

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10


1/49 W

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6

Uniformity
200 Continuous row spacing up to 5.2 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

Chapter 6 / 31

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

2LIGHT E1-Mini/TC-TELI/HIT and E3 TC-L

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

32 / Chapter 6
1/75 W FL-S 1/20 W S 1/42 W

Ceiling height: 3 m

2LIGHT 1/75 W FL-S 2LIGHT 1/20 W S 2LIGHT 1/42 W E1 TC-TELI 2LIGHT 1/70 W E1 HIT G8.5 2LIGHT 1/80 W E3 TC-L 2LIGHT 2/55 W E3 TC-L

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 55 / *65 / **75 *200 cd/m 2 < 16 < 16 1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 16 < 19 < 19 *1000 cd/m 2 200 cd/m 2 < 19 < 16 < 19 < 19 **1000 cd/m 2 **1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 22

Maintenance factor (MF)

1/80 W 2/55 W 1/70 W

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation (1/75 1000 h) Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance MF= 0.78 2000 h 1 year 1 year

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 3.4 m (1/42 W); up to 3.9 m (1/80 W)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

200

Floor area m2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
1/35 W

RTX II C or D
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m UGR_axial UGR_transv.

50 24 18 12 6

40
1/49 W 1/54 W 2/35 W 2/54 W

RTX2 1/35 W + D RTX2 1/49 W + D RTX2 1/54 W + D RTX2 2/35 W + D RTX2 2/54 W + D

< 16 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 19

< 16 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 22

65 < 200 cd/m2 < 200 cd/m2 < 200 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2 < 1000 cd/m2

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.3 m 1-lamp, up to 4 m 2-lamp

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 33

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30
1/35 W

RTX II C-ID T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

34 / Chapter 6
24 18 12 6
1/49 W 2/35 W 2/54 W

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

RTX2 C-ID 1/35 W T16 RTX2 C-ID 1/49 W T16 RTX2 C-ID 2/35 W T16 RTX2 C-ID 2/54 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m 2

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 4000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.5 m 1-lamp, up to 3.9 m 2-lamp

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15 12 9 6 3 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.3 1.7 2.2

Free-standing uplights
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.5 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.3 1.4 1.5

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

25

20

LIGHT FIELDS-S 3/55 W TC-L LIGHT FIELDS-S 3/80 W TC-L KAREA-S SYM 4/55 W TC-L LANOS-S SYM 4/55 W TC-L

65 UGR_axial UGR_transv. <13 <13 < 1500 cd/m2 <13 <13 < 1500 cd/m2 <13 <13 <13 <13

15

L-FIELDS 3/55 W

Maintenance factor (MF)

KAREA 4/55 W

10

LANOS 4/55 W

L-FIELDS 3/80 W

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.72 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Max. axial spacing up to 7.2 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 35

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
1/54 W

TECTON(-I) + RW T16
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

36 / Chapter 6
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3 18 12 6

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

TECTON 1/54 W T16 + RW TECTON 1/54 W T16+PK+RW TECTON 2/54 W T16 + RW TECTON-I 2/54 W T16 + R

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 25 < 28 < 22 < 28 < 28 < 25 < 25

40

1/54 W+PK

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20
2/54 W -I 2/54 W

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 6000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 5.6 m/4.8 m (-I 2/54 W+R)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18
1/80 W+PK 1/80 W

TECTON(-I) + RW T16
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

TECTON 1/80 W T16 + RW TECTON 1/80 W T16+PK+RW TECTON 2/80 W T16 + RW TECTON-I 2/80 W T16 + R

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 25 < 28 < 22 < 28 < 28 < 25 < 25

40

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

20
2/80 W -I 2/80 W

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 6000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 5.6 m/4.8 m (-I 2/80 W+R)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 37

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
1/54 W 1/80 W 2/54 W 2/80 W

TECTON-IP Louvre T16


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

38 / Chapter 6
18 12 6

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

TECTON-IP 1/54 W T16 TECTON-IP 1/80 W T16 TECTON-IP 2/54 W T16 TECTON-IP 2/80 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 19 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 6000 h 2 years 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 4.4 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
ML-B 2/49 W

TECTON D-ML-B and ML-C


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

TECTON D ML-B 2/54 W TECTON D ML-B 2/49 W TECTON D ML-C 2/49 W TECTON D ML-C 2/54 W

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m 2

40 18
ML-B 2/54 W ML-C 2/49 W

30 12 6

Maintenance factor (MF)

20
ML-C 2/54 W

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 4000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.5 m for ML-B and up to 3.9 m for ML-C

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 39

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
18 15 height
2/54 W + I 2/54 W + ID 2/80 W + I 2/80 W + ID

TECTON D-ID and -I


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 (1.5 for D-I) Ceiling Floor area

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

40 / Chapter 6
12 9 6 3 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m ID I 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.7 1.6 2.2 over 50 m ID I 1.1 1.2 1.2 1.4 1.3 1.5

Ceiling height: 3 m

25

TECTON D-ID 2/54 W T16 TECTON D-ID 2/80 W T16 TECTON D-I 2/54 W T16 TECTON D-I 2/80 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 16 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 13 < 13 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 13 < 13 < 1000 cd/m 2

20

15

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Wartung (D-I 1/2 year) Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing D-ID up to 4.2 m, D-I up to 7 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15
2/35 W

TECTON D-PL (Pool-Light)


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

25 12 9
2/80 W

TECTON D-PL 2/35 W T16 TECTON D-PL 2/49 W T16 TECTON D-PL 2/80 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 19 < 19 < 22 < 19 < 1000 cd/m 2

20
2/49 W

height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

15 6 3

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.77 2000 h 1 year 1 year

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 6 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 41

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
18 15

COPA I 250 W
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

42 / Chapter 6
12 9 6 3 Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of lumin. (IP65) Room maintenance MF=0.79 (HIE) 4000 h 1 year 1 year MF=0.83 (HSE) 8000 h 3 years 3 years

Ceiling height: 6 m

25

1/250 W HIE RAB 19000 lm TST 1/250 W HSE RAB 25000 lm TST

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 16 < 16 < 1000 cd/ m2 < 16 < 19 < 1000 cd/ m2

20

1/250 W HIE

15

1/250 W HSE

10

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 5 m (TST)

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15

COPA I 400 W
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 6 m

25 12 9 6 3

1/400 W HIE RAB 36000 lm 1/400 W HSE RAB 36000 lm* 1/400 W HSE RAB 47000 lm**

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65/75 < 19 75< 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 75< 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 16 < 16 65< 1000 cd/m2

20

15

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of lumin. (IP65) Room maintenance

MF=0.70 (HIE) 2000 h 1 year 1 year

MF=0.83 (HSE) 8000 h 3 years 3 years

1/400 W HIE

10
HSE**

1/400 W HSE*

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 8.3 m
* (Colour rendition Ra > 60) ** (Colour rendition Ra > 20)

1/400 W

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Chapter 6 / 43

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6 height 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4

COPA D RKF/RKID 32/42/57/85 W


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.1 1.2

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

44 / Chapter 6 Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room MF= 0.78 Lamp operation 2000 h Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) 1 year Room maintenance 2 years

Ceiling height: 4 m

50

1/32 W

40

COPA D 1/32 W RKF/RKID COPA D 1/42 W RKF/RKID COPA D 1/57 W RKF COPA D 1/57 W RKID COPA D 1/85 W RKF COPA D 1/85 W RKID

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 / 75 < 16 65< 200 cd/m2 < 16 < 19 75< 200 cd/m2 < 19 < 25 < 25 < 22 75< 1000 cd/m2 < 22 < 19 65< 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 < 19 65< 1000 cd/m2

1/42 W

30

1/57 W

1/85 W

20

10

Uniformity
180 200 Axial spacing up to 5 m, up to 5.4 m (42 W RKF), up to 5.7 m (42 W RKID, 57 W RKF, RKID)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m2

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15
1/70 W

COPA D HIT 70/150 W


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 over 50 m 1.1 1.2

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 4 m

25 12 9 6 3

COPA D 1/70 W HIT (6400 lm) COPA D 1/150 W HIT (14000 lm)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 / *75 < 19 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 22 < 22 *< 1000 cd/m2

20

15

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room MF= 0.77 (HCI) Lamp operation 2000 h Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) 1 year Room maintenance 2 years

10

1/150 W

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 4 m 180 200

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 45

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
1/250 W

COPA D 250 W QT
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 over 50 m 1.1 1.2

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

46 / Chapter 6
18 12 6

Ceiling height: 4 m UGR_axial UGR_transv.

50

COPA D 1/250 W QT

< 19

< 19

65 <1000 cd/m2

40

30

Maintenance factor (MF)


Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) Room maintenance MF= 0.76 1000 h 1 year 2 years

20

10

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 4.5 m 180 200

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15

COPA A-B HIT/HST 250 W


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 6 m

25
1/250 W HIT 1/250 W HST

COPA A-B 1/250 W HIT (20000 lm) COPA A-B 1/250 W HST (23000 lm) COPA A-B 2/250 W HIT (40000 lm) COPA A-B 2/250 W HST (46000 lm)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 28 < 28 < 25 < 28 < 28 < 25

20 9 6 3

12

15
2/250 W HST 2/250 W HIT

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of lumin. (IP65) Room maintenance

MF=0.80 (HIT) 2000 h 1 year 2 years

MF=0.81 (HST) 14000 h 1 year 2 years

10

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to: 7.5 m HST, up to 8.3 m 2/250 W HIT, up to 9 m 1/250 W HIT

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Chapter 6 / 47

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
18 15

COPA A-B HIT/HST 400 W


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

48 / Chapter 6
12
1/400 W HIT

Ceiling height: 6 m

25

COPA A_B 1/400 W HIT (32000 lm) * COPA A_B 1/400 W HST (48000 lm) **

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 28 < 28 < 28

20 9 6
1/400 W HST

15

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of lumin. (IP65) Room maintenance

MF=0.67 (HIT) 1000 h 1 year 2 years

MF=0.81 (HST) 14000 h 1 year 2 years

10 3

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 9 m
* (Colour rendition Ra > 90) ** (Colour rendition Ra > 20)

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30

COPA A-N HME


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 6 m

50 24
1/250 W

COPA A-N 1/250 W HME (13000 lm) COPA A-N 1/400 W HME (22000 lm)

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 28 < 29 < 29

40 18
1/400 W

30 12 6

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) Room maintenance

MF= 0.80 2000 h 1 year 2 years

20

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 9 m

10

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Chapter 6 / 49

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
6 5

COPA A-B, A-T, A-ASY HST


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

10

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

50 / Chapter 6
4 3
A-T 1/600 W

Ceiling height: 6 m

UGR_axial UGR_transv.

COPA A-B 1/600 W HST COPA A-T 1/600 W HST COPA A-ASY 1/600 W HST

< 25

< 28

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) Room maintenance

MF= 0.83 10000 h 2 years 2 years

4 2 1

A-B 1/600 W A-ASY 1/600 W

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 6.3 m (ASY), up to 7.5 m (A-B)

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
18 15

COPA A-ASY HIT/HST


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Maintenance factor (MF)

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 6 m

25 12
1/250 W HST 1/400 W HIT

COPA A-ASY 1/250 W HIT (20000 lm) COPA A-ASY 1/250 W HST (27000 lm) COPA A-ASY 1/400 W HIT (32000 lm) COPA A-ASY 1/400 W HST (48000 lm)

20 9 6 3

1/250 W HIT

15

Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires (IP65) Room maintenance

MF= 0.81 (HST) 14000 h 2 years 2 years

10

1/400 W HST

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

400

450

500

Chapter 6 / 51

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 (O=1.25) Maintenance factor (MF) (D)
Clean large room Lamp operation Cleaning of lumin. (IP65) Room maintenance MF= 0.79 (D) 4000 h 2 years 2 years

PERLUCE D/O

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

52 / Chapter 6 (O)
MF= 0.83 (O) 2000 h 1 year 1 year
O 2/18 W TC-L

Ceiling height: 3 m

PERLUCE D 1/49 W T16 PERLUCE D 1/80 W T16 PERLUCE O 2/18 W TC-L PERLUCE O 1/49 W T16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 16 < 16 <1000 cd/m 2 < 16 < 19 <1000 cd/m 2 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 19

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 3.9 m (D) and up to 6.5 m (O)

140 130 120 110 100 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10


O 1/49 W T16 D 1/49 W T16 D 1/80 W T16

86 80 72 66 60 54 48 42 36 30 24 18 12 6 200

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

RAIN
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

RAIN 1/58 W T 26 RAIN 1/80 W T 16 RAIN 2/36 W T 26 RAIN 2/54 W T 16

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 28 < 22 < 29 < 25 < 28 < 22 < 29 < 22

40

30
1/58 W T26 1/80 W T16 2/54 W T16

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

2/36 W T26

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 8 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 53

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
54 48 42 36
1/55 W

CHIARO FTR390/FTR680 T16-R


Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area

90

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

54 / Chapter 6
30 24 18 12 6 180 200 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3
22+ 40 W

80

Ceiling height: 3 m

70

CHIARO FTR 1/40 W T16-R CHIARO FTR 1/55 W T16-R CHIARO FTR 1/22 W+40W T16-R CHIARO FTR 2/40 W T16-R

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22 < 22

60

50

1/40 W

40

Maintenance factor (MF)

30

2/40 W

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Luminaire maintenance Room maintenance

MF= 0.76 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
Axial spacing up to 4.5 m, up to 5 m 2/40 W

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24 18 12 6 height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6

SCUBA T26
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.25 Ceiling Floor area
over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

25

SCUBA 1/36 W T26 SCUBA 1/58 W T26 SCUBA 2/36 W T26 SCUBA 2/58 W T26

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 19 < 25 < 19 < 25 < 19 < 25 < 22

20

1/36 W

15

1/58 W

2/36 W

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

2/58 W

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 6000 h 1 year 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 8.5 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 55

Floor area m2

500 lx 300 lx
18
C-O 4/24 W T16

CLEAN C-O/R
15 12
C-O 3/40 W TC-L

30

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

56 / Chapter 6 Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3 9
C-R 3/55 W TC-L

Ceiling height: 3 m

25

CLEAN C-O 4/24 W T16 CLEAN C-O 3/40 W TC-L CLEAN C-R 3/55 W TC-L

UGR_axial UGR_transv. < 22 < 22 < 25 < 25 < 19 < 22

20

15 6 3

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation (-O = 4000 h) Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 3000 h 2 years 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 4.5 m, with 3/55 W up to 3.9 m

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

500 lx 300 lx
36 30 24
A-O 2/49 W T16

CLEAN A-C/O
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

60

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m

50

CLEAN A-C 2/49 W T16 CLEAN A-O 2/49 W T16 CLEAN A-C 3/40 W TC-L CLEAN A-C 3/55 W TC-L

65/75 UGR_axial UGR_transv. 65 < 1000 cd/m2 < 16 < 19 < 22 < 22 < 19 < 19 75 < 1000 cd/m2 < 19 < 19 75 < 1000 cd/m2

40 18 12 6

30
A-C 3/40 W TC-L A-C 2/49 W T16 A-C 3/55 W TC-L

Maintenance factor (MF)

20

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation (TC-L 3000 h) Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.78 4000 h (T16) 2 years 2 years

Uniformity Continuous row spacing up


180 200 to 3.9 m (2/49 W A-C), up to 4.5 m (2/49 W A-O), up to 4.2 m (TC-L)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Chapter 6 / 57

Floor area m

500 lx 300 lx
18 15 12
S-R 2/49 W

CLEAN S-C/R
Correction factors Dark room (50/40/20): 1.1 Ceiling Floor area
height 4m 5m 6m up to 50 m 1.2 1.4 1.6 over 50 m 1.1 1.2 1.3

30

58 / Chapter 6
9
S-C 3/49 W S-C 3/80 W

X=4H Y=8H / S=0.25H / Reflection factors 70/50/20

Ceiling height: 3 m UGR_axial UGR_transv.

25

CLEAN S-C 3/49 W CLEAN S-C 3/80 W CLEAN S-R 2/49 W

< 16 < 19 < 22

< 19 < 19 < 22

75 < 1000 cd/m 2 < 1000 cd/m 2

20

15 6 3

Maintenance factor (MF)

10

Clean medium-sized room Lamp operation Cleaning of luminaires Room maintenance

MF= 0.79 4000 h 2 years 2 years

Uniformity
180 200 Continuous row spacing up to 3.9 m and up to 4.5 m (2/49 S-R)

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

Floor area m

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7

Technical information
Protection classes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Degrees of protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fire protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Explosion-proofness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Requirements concerning safety ball-proofness . . . . . Clean-room technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chemical effects on materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Short-circuit protection and loading of circuits . . . . . . . Low-voltage installations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 35 67 89 10 11 13 14 16 17 24 25 27

Protection classes
ZUMTOBEL luminaires are classified into the following protection classes a measure intended to afford protection against electric shock. Class I luminaires Class I is not identified by a symbol; the luminaire is intended to be connected to a protective earth conductor which bears the mark. Most ZUMTOBEL luminaires are designed in accordance with protection class I unless otherwise stated. Class II luminaires Class II luminaires have total insulation but no protective earth terminal. The ZUMTOBEL range includes protection class II luminaires, for instance moisture-proof batten luminaires and moisture-proof diffuser luminaires. Class III luminaires Class III identifies luminaires that are intended for operation with protective extra low voltage (50 V max.). ZUMTOBEL architectural luminaires include class III luminaires, e.g. PRIO low-voltage spotlights. Protection class I Protection class II Protection class III

Degrees of protection
Degrees of protection indicate the following properties of equipment: The quality of its protection against direct contact Its sealing against ingress of solid foreign bodies (dust, stones, sand, etc.) Its sealing against the ingress of water

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 3

The type of protection is defined by two degrees of protection in accordance with IEC 529: Degree of shock-hazard protection and protection against ingress of solid foreign bodies (1st digit) Degree of protection against the ingress of water (2nd digit) For example IP 23: IP
INGRESS PROTECTION Protection against ingress of solid foreign bodies having > 12 mm (medium-sized solid bodies), insertion of fingers or objects. Protection against ingress of water falling at any angle up to 60 from vertical. There must be no adverse effect (spray water).

Degrees of protection for technical luminaires Protection against ingress of solid foreign bodies as per first digit IP 0X IP 1X IP 2X IP 3X IP 4X IP 5X IP 6X Unprotected against ingress of solid foreign bodies Protection against solid bodies > 50 mm Protection against solid bodies > 12 mm Protection against solid bodies > 2.5 mm Protection against solid bodies > 1 mm Dust-protected (limited ingress of dust) Dust-tight (no ingress of dust)

Protection against moisture as per second digit IP X0 IP X1 IP X2 IP X3 IP X4 IP X5 IP X6 IP X7 IP X8 No special protection Drip-proof protection against water drops Protection against water drops up to 15 from the vertical Rainproof protection against spray water up to 60 Splash-proof protection against spray water from all directions Jet-proof protection against jets of water Protection against heavy seas (conditions on ship decks) Watertight protection against immersion (pressure and time specified) Protection against immersion under pressure (with instructions from manufacturer)

4 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Applications for luminaires with increased protection Damp locations Bakeries Manure sheds Animal-feed preparation facilities Industrial kitchens Boiler rooms Commercial workshops Granaries (Deep-freeze) cold storage Pump houses Sculleries Laundries Wet locations Beer or wine cellars Shower cubicles Meat processing facilities Electroplating facilities Greenhouses Dairies Workshops using wet processes Car wash areas Agricultural facilities IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP 20 IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP X1 IP X4 IP X4 IP X5 IP X4 IP X4 IP X4 IP X4 IP X4
The following generally applies: IP X5: for cleaning using water jets IP X4: in rinsing areas

The following generally applies: IP X5: for cleaning using water jets

Beer or wine cellars IP 44 Shower cubicles IP 44 Stores, storerooms for hay, straw, feedstuff IP 44 Intensive stock farming IP 44 Animal sheds IP 44 Adjoining rooms of animal sheds IP 44 Facilities with increased fire risk Workrooms Woodworking Sawmills Paper processing Textile processing Treatment and fabrication Gymnasia and sports halls
The Lighting Handbook

The following generally applies: IP X5: for cleaning using water jets IP 54+FF: when increased fire risk

IP 50 IP 50 IP 50 IP 50 IP 50 IP 50 IP 20 IP 20 IP 20 IP 20
ballproof luminaires ballproof luminaires with all-round cover; maximum mesh size 60 mm

Badminton courts Squash courts Indoor tennis courts Gymnasia and sports halls

Chapter 7 / 5

Fire protection
Luminaire identification marking The following criteria must be taken into account: Position of normal use Fire behaviour of environment and mounting surfaces Minimum clearance from combustible substances and materials Luminaires with thecmark Luminaires which carry thecmark must be constructed so that the temperature on the mounting surface does not exceed 130 C during abnormal operation, and does not exceed 180 C in the event of a ballast fault. Luminaires with this mark are suitable for direct mounting on parts of buildings made of non-combustible, flame-retardant or normally flammable building materials according to DIN 4102. Luminaires with the d/Umark Both marks regulate the surface temperatures of luminaires. External surfaces on which readily flammable substances such as dust or fibrous materials may accumulate when luminaires are installed as prescribed must not exceed specific temperatures. The d luminaire mark was withdrawn in 1999. A validity transition period allows the d mark to be used until 01. 08. 2005. TheUmark introduced in EN 60598 has applied since 01.08.1998. The d mark limits the temperature on horizontal surfaces to 95 C during normal operation and 115 C in the event of a ballast fault. Temperatures must not exceed 220 C on vertical surfaces. In order to fulfil the criteria of the Umark, the surface temperature on horizontal surfaces must not exceed 90 C. The maximum temperature in the event of a fault is 115 C, the same as for the d mark. The temperature must not exceed 150 C on vertical surfaces. Luminaires with theQmark Luminaires which carry theQmark are intended for installation in furniture. They are designed so that in the event of a ballast fault, flame-retardant and normally flammable materials as specified in DIN 4102 cannot be ignited, e.g. in corners of wooden furniture. The materials may be painted, veneered or varnished. Luminaires with the q mark Luminaires which carry the q mark are intended for mounting in or on furniture made of materials whose flammability is not known. They are designed so that in normal operation any mounting surface or other adjacent furniture surfaces do not exceed a temperature of 95 C. 6 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Fire protection: Place of use Mark Requirements

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 7

Explosion-proofness
Flammable gases, vapours and mists Zone O: A hazardous explosive atmosphere is present continuously or long term. Zone 1: A hazardous explosive atmosphere can be expected to occur occasionally. Zone 2: A hazardous explosive atmosphere can be expected to occur only rarely and, if any, short term. Combustible dusts Zone 20 includes areas in which there is a permanent, longterm or frequent explosive atmosphere consisting of dust-air mixtures. Zone 21 includes areas in which an explosive atmosphere consisting of dust-air mixtures can be expected to occur occasionally and short term. Zone 22 includes areas in which an explosive atmosphere cannot be expected to occur due to disturbance of deposited dust. If an explosive atmosphere should nevertheless occur, this will most probably happen only rarely and short term.

Directive 94/9/EC The new Directive 94/9/EC specifies the requirements for all devices and protection systems for use in explosion-prone areas. Over and above this, this Directive now directly includes the basic safety requirements for explosion-proof equipment. Manufacturers of explosion-proof equipment have to provide evidence of a quality assurance system to be tested by a notified body.

8 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Directive 99/92 EC (Workplace Directive) Also new is the description of hazard areas in explosion-prone workplaces, and a resulting graded safety profile for the equipment used. As this Directive was drafted according to the ECs new approach, the manufacturers declaration of conformity, combined with CE marking of the products, was introduced

for explosion-proof equipment as well. A detailed commentary on Directive 94/9/EC is included in the Directive 94/9/EC by the European Parliament and the Council of 23 March 1994 section. Since 1 July 2003, it has superseded all directives on explosion protection previously effective at European level. Please note: The previous standard on construction and testing of explosion-proof equipment for Zone 2 has been superseded by ILC 60079-15/EN 60079-15, which specifies higher requirements for Zone 2 luminaires (higher requirements in terms of electronic ballasts and impact resistance).

Equipment of Group 2 including potential ignition source


Equipment cat. 1 Equipment cat. 2 Electrical appliance Equipment cat. 3

Yes

No Engine with internal combustion

EC type examination

Documentation of notified body

Documentation of manufacturer

Internal production control

Basic safety and health requirements

Classification of max. surface temperatures in electrical equipment of Class 2


Temperature class T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 Max. permissible surface temperature of equipment in C 450 300 200 135 100 85 Ignition temperatures of flammable substances in C > 450 > 300 450 > 300 200 > 200 135 > 100 135 > 85 100

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 9

Requirements concerning safety ball-proofness


Luminaires for sports halls must be ball-proof according to DIN VDE 0710-13. Balls hitting luminaires must not damage them so as to cause luminaire parts to fall down. In a test conforming with the relevant standard, the luminaire has to withstand 36 hits from three directions at a maximum impact speed of 60 km/h, the ball used having the size of a handball. When choosing the luminaires, the rod guards grid width must be matched to the sport played in the hall: it must always be considerably smaller than the balls used, never of the same size, as balls may get stuck in the guard. As ball-proof luminaires, the ZUMTOBEL range includes the RAS/RES-BWS louvre luminaire as well as the COPA-A high-bay luminaire.

10 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Clean-room technology
Clean-room compatibility tested CLEAN Advanced and CLEAN Supreme have been tested and assessed by the Fraunhofer Institute in Stuttgart (Germany) with respect to clean-room compatibility for clean-rooms (particle emission behaviour of the luminaires) and cleanliness compatibility (disinfectability, electrostatic behaviour and chemical resistance).

Details on clean-room compatibility: The German VDI 2083 Guideline specifies a standardised procedure for all equipment used in a clean-room. The common criterion for the clean-room compatibility of luminaires and all other equipment is their particle emission behaviour. Airborne particle emission is used as a classification criterion in all international standards. The relevant maximum value for the permissible concentration of particles of a specific particle size constitutes the class limit. Test setup A defined volume of air is aspirated by an air sampling probe and fed into a test chamber. The particles inside this test chamber are monitored and recorded appropriately. Exceeding the relevant limit values is decisive in order to classify the luminaires. If a limit value is not exceeded with a certainty of at least 95 %, the respective item of equipment may be regarded as suitable for use in this air cleanliness class.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 11

Details on cleanliness compatibility: In order to be able to confirm cleanliness compatibility as well as quantities reflecting clean-room compatibility that can be detected by metrological methods, additional expert assessments and parameters were included in the tests conducted by the Fraunhofer Institute IPA. Cleanliness compatibility covers a large number of sector-based cleanliness requirements such as resistance to chemicals, surface quality, flow behaviour or electrostatic charge characteristics. These are defined in the following standards and codes of practice, among others: Standardisation General: classification of air cleanliness clean-rooms and associated controlled environments according to DIN EN ISO 14644-1 (Federal Standard 209 has been withdrawn) clean-room technology and clean-room compatibility of equipment VDI 2083 EHEDG (European Hygienic Engineering & Design Group) Industrial application areas: GMP Guidelines (Good Manufacturing Practice) pharmaceuticals FDA (Food and Drug Administration) pharmaceuticals and foodstuffs Medicinal Product Law EU Pharmaceutical Regulation Good manufacturing practices Volume 4 (Medicinal products for human and veterinary use) Hazard Analytical Control Point (HACCP) Regulations foodstuffs Hospital application areas: VDI 2167 Building services in hospitals DIN 1946-4 Ventilation and air conditioning Part 4 (Ventilation in hospitals)

12 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Airflow systems in clean-rooms: One of the basic criteria for the requirements placed on equipment in clean-rooms is the nature of the airflow system. The CLEAN clean-room luminaire has been designed for use in all clean-room classes with a turbulent mixed airflow. In this commonly encountered airflow system, air enters the room with a turbulent flow, thereby causing continuous dilution and cleaning. According to GMP (Good Manufacturing Practice) classification, clean-room Classes C to E and ISO Classes 6 to 9 can be achieved using this airflow system. Clean-rooms with low-turbulence displacement flow, which are more expensive to build, allow air to initially enter the cleanroom with low turbulence. The design of laminar flow cleanrooms precludes the use of any luminaires other than extremely slim batten luminaires which disrupt the directional flow of air as little as possible. The laminar flow system minimises contamination, and any contaminant is quickly eliminated. Cleanrooms in ISO Classes 1 to 6 and GMP Classes A and B are areas where this airflow system is used.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 13

Chemical effects on materials


No material is resistant to all chemical influences. The effects of chemicals vary widely and take up entire volumes of resistance tables. The table on the opposite page can therefore only give a brief overview of effects of some frequently occurring chemicals and is subject to the following conditions: The chemical substance listed in the table is a basic material and not part of a chemical compound. The ambient temperature is 22 C. A great many complaints could be avoided if due consideration were given during the planning stage to the situation in which the luminaire is going to be used. What are the key factors? 1. Luminaire materials A luminaire consists of several parts having different functions and which are therefore made from different materials (base plate, cover, seal, closures, cable inlets, etc.). 5. Ambient temperature Depending on the type and composition of the substances, chemical reactions will take place over a range of temperatures. We should be glad to provide further advice if you have any questions or doubts about the resistance of any materials. 2. Applications The following applications are just a few examples of situations in which material damage may occur: Chemical and petrochemical industry Foodstuffs industry (cheese production, dairies, meat processing, breweries) Agriculture Fishing industry Kitchens and industrial cooking facilities Car wash facilities Production facilities and workshops using a high level of oil and grease 3. Chemical composition The chemical composition should be discussed with every operator. 4. Degree of saturation of chemical substances

14 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Chemical substance in question

Stainless Alusteel minium

Poly- Polymeth- Polyester acrylate..carbonate

The Lighting Handbook

Acetic acid up to 5 % Acetic acid up to 30 % Acetone Alcohol up to 30 % Alcohol, concentrated Aliphatic hydrocarbons Ammonia 25 % Aniline Aromatic hydrocarbons Battery acid Beer Benzene Blood Bromic acid Carbon dioxide Carbon monoxide Carbon tetrachloride Caustic soda solution 2 % Caustic soda solution 10 % Chloroform Chlorophenol Diesel oil, crude oil Dioxan Ether Ethyl acetate (ester) Glycerine Glycol Glysantin Hydrochloric acid up to 20 % above 20 % Hydrogen peroxide up to 40 % over 40 %

= resistant, = resistant to limited extent, = not resistant

Chapter 7 / 15

Chemical substance in question

Stainless Alusteel minium

Poly- Polymeth- Polyester acrylate..carbonate

Ketones Lime milk Lysol Methylene chloride Methanol Metal salts and their aqueous solutions Naphtha (cleaners naphtha) Petrolium ether Pyridine Phenol Nitric acid up to 10 % up to 20 % above 20 % Sea water Soap-suds Soda Sodium chloride solution Sulphuretted hydrogen Sulphuric acid up to 50 % up to 70 % above 70 % Sulphurous acid up to 5 % Synthetic detergents Turpentine Water up to 60C Xylene

= resistant, = resistant to limited extent, = not resistant

16 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Short-circuit protection and loading of circuits


Miniature circuit breakers Trip characteristic B C D Rangeh over 3 ln to 5 ln over 5 ln to 10 ln over 10 ln to 20 ln

Maximum number of fluorescent lamps per miniature circuit breaker Number of fluorescent lamps with conventional or low-loss ballast for different lamp circuits
C10 C16 n.k./p.k. n.k./p.k. 1/18 W T26 44/53 73/86 1/3638 W T26 38/53 63/86 1/58 W T26 25/34 40/56 1/57 W TC-S 83/135 136/221 1/9 W TC-S 93/135 153/221 1/11 W TC-S 104/135 170/221 1/1013 W TC-D 72/122 119/200 1/18 W TC-D/-T 62/91 102/149 1/26 W TC-D/-T 43/68 71/112 1/18 W TC-L/-F 44/53 73/86 1/24 W TC-L/-F 41/53 68/86 1/36 W TC-L/-F 38/53 62/86 n. k. = no p.f. correction (inductive) B10 B16 B20 n.k./p.k. n.k./p.k. n.k./p.k. 27/32 43/51 53/63 23/32 37/51 46/63 15/20 24/33 30/41 50/81 80/130 100/162 56/81 90/130 112/162 63/81 100/130 125/162 44/74 70/118 87/147 37/55 60/88 75/110 26/41 42/66 52/82 27/32 43/51 53/63 25/32 40/51 50/63 23/32 37/51 46/63 p. k. = shunt p.f. correction

Loading of automatic circuit breakers for metal halide lamps Maximum recommended number of electronic ballasts per automatic circuit breaker Electronic ballasts for metal halide lamps, non-dimmable (TRIDONIC.ATCO PCI series, except for PCI... A101/A201/A202)
C10 1.5 mm2 30 30 14 14 7 10 7 C13 1.5 mm2 40 40 25 25 14 18 14 C16 1.5 mm2 50 50 36 36 20 26 20 C20 2.5 mm2 60 60 42 42 20 30 20 B10 1.5 mm2 15 15 8 8 4 6 4 B13 1.5 mm2 20 20 14 14 6 10 6 B16 1.5 mm2 25 25 18 18 7 13 7 B20 2.5 mm2 30 30 18 18 7 13 7

The Lighting Handbook

1/20 W HI 1/35 W HI 2/35 W HI 1/70 W HI 2/70 W HI 1/100 W HI 1/150 W HI

Depending on type of unit, a larger number of units may be possible.

Chapter 7 / 17

Loading of automatic circuit breakers for electronic ballasts for fluorescent and compact fluorescent lamps Maximum recommended number of electronic ballasts per automatic circuit breaker Electronic ballasts for T16 fluorescent lamps, non-dimming (TRIDONIC.ATCO PC T5 PRO lp series)
C10 C13 C16 C20 B10 B13 B16 B20 1.5 1.5 1.5 2.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 2.5 mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 mm2 1x14/21/28/35 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 2x14/21/28/35 W T16 18 24 28 34 9 12 14 17 3/14 W T16 26 38 44 64 13 19 22 32 4/14 W T16 26 38 44 64 13 19 22 32 1/24 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 2/24 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 3/24 W T16 14 18 22 28 7 9 11 14 4/24 W T16 14 18 22 28 7 9 11 14 1/39 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 2/39 W T16 18 28 30 36 9 14 15 18 1/49 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 2/49 W T16 18 28 30 36 9 14 15 18 1/54 W T16 28 40 44 58 14 20 22 29 2/54 W T16 14 20 24 30 7 10 12 15 1/80 W T16 18 28 30 36 9 14 15 22 2/80 W T16 8 14 16 20 4 7 8 10

Electronic ballasts for T26 fluorescent lamps, non-dimming (TRIDONIC.ATCO PC T8 PRO series)
C10 1.5 mm2 44 36 40 30 40 22 38 24 18 36 16 36 16 C13 1.5 mm2 62 50 60 40 52 30 52 32 24 50 22 50 22 C16 1.5 mm2 74 60 80 52 60 38 60 38 32 60 26 60 26 C20 2.5 mm2 104 72 92 64 72 42 72 44 40 70 30 70 30 B10 1.5 mm2 22 18 20 15 19 11 19 12 9 18 8 18 8 B13 1.5 mm2 31 25 30 20 26 15 26 16 12 25 11 25 11 B16 1.5 mm2 37 30 40 26 30 19 30 19 16 30 13 30 13 B20 2.5 mm2 52 36 46 32 36 21 36 22 20 35 15 35 15

18 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

1/18 W 2/18 W 3/18 W 4/18 W 1/30 W 2/30 W 1/36 W 2/36 W 3/36 W 1/58 W 2/58 W 1/70 W 2/70 W

T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26

Electronic ballasts for T16 fluorescent lamps, dimmable (TRIDONIC.ATCO PCA T5 ECO/EXCEL one4all (lp) series)
C10 1.5 mm2 50 38 16 16 50 30 38 24 34 16 50 24 34 16 24 12 24 12 14 10 C13 1.5 mm2 80 54 26 24 80 40 54 34 50 22 80 34 50 22 34 18 34 18 20 14 C16 1.5 mm2 150 78 34 34 120 60 78 48 76 30 150 48 70 30 48 26 48 26 28 20 C20 2.5 mm2 180 92 42 38 150 64 92 52 86 32 180 52 86 32 52 26 52 26 28 22 B10 1.5 mm2 25 19 8 8 25 15 19 12 17 8 25 12 17 8 12 6 12 6 7 5 B13 1.5 mm2 40 27 13 12 40 20 27 17 25 11 40 17 25 11 17 9 17 9 10 7 B16 1.5 mm2 75 39 17 17 60 30 39 24 38 15 75 24 38 15 24 13 24 13 14 10 B20 2.5 mm2 90 46 21 19 75 32 46 26 43 16 90 26 43 16 26 13 26 13 14 11

1/14 W 2/14 W 3/14 W 4/14 W 1/21 W 2/21 W 1/28 W 2/28 W 1/35 W 2/35 W 1/24 W 2/24 W 1/39 W 2/39 W 1/49 W 2/49 W 1/54 W 2/54 W 1/80 W 2/80 W

T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16 T16

Electronic ballasts for T26 fluorescent lamps, dimmable (TRIDONIC.ATCO PCA T8 ECO/EXCEL one4all series)
C10 1.5 mm2 30 20 16 12 30 10 30 10 30 10 20 10 C13 1.5 mm2 50 30 18 16 50 20 50 20 50 20 30 20 C16 1.5 mm2 76 40 24 24 70 30 70 30 70 30 40 30 C20 2.5 mm2 80 46 30 28 76 30 76 30 76 30 46 30 B10 1.5 mm2 15 10 8 6 15 5 15 5 15 5 10 5 B13 1.5 mm2 25 15 9 8 25 10 25 10 25 10 15 10 B16 1.5 mm2 38 20 12 12 35 15 35 15 35 15 20 15 B20 2.5 mm2 40 23 15 14 38 15 38 15 38 15 23 15

The Lighting Handbook

1/18 W 2/18 W 3/18 W 4/18 W 1/30 W 2/30 W 1/36 W 2/36 W 1/38 W 2/38 W 1/58 W 2/58 W

T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26 T26

Chapter 7 / 19

Electronic ballasts for TC-L fluorescent lamps, non-dimmable (TRIDONIC.ATCO PC TCL PRO series)
C10 1.5 mm2 30 24 30 24 38 24 38 14 28 8 C13 1.5 mm2 40 32 40 32 54 34 54 24 38 14 C16 1.5 mm2 48 38 48 38 76 44 78 28 50 18 C20 2.5 mm2 60 46 60 46 90 50 90 34 60 20 B10 1.5 mm2 15 12 15 12 19 12 19 7 14 4 B13 1.5 mm2 20 16 20 16 27 17 27 12 19 7 B16 1.5 mm2 24 19 24 19 38 22 39 14 25 9 B20 2.5 mm2 30 23 30 23 45 25 45 17 30 10

1/18 W 2/18 W 1/24 W 2/24 W 1/36 W 2/36 W 1/40 W 2/40 W 1/55 W 2/55 W

TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L

Electronic ballasts for TC-L compact fluorescent lamps, Basic dimming/Dali dimming (TRIDONIC.ATCO PCA TCL ECO/ EXCEL one4all series)
C10 1.5 mm2 10 16 30 10 30 10 20 10 10 C13 1.5 mm2 12 20 50 20 50 20 30 14 20 C16 1.5 mm2 16 24 70 30 70 30 40 18 30 C20 2.5 mm2 20 30 76 30 76 30 46 20 30 B10 1.5 mm2 5 8 15 5 15 5 10 5 5 B13 1.5 mm2 6 10 25 10 25 10 15 7 10 B16 1.5 mm2 8 12 35 15 35 15 20 9 15 B20 2.5 mm2 10 15 38 15 38 15 23 10 15

2/18 W 2/24 W 1/36 W 2/36 W 1/40 W 2/40 W 1/55 W 2/55 W 1/80 W

TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L TC-L

20 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Electronic ballasts for TC-DEL/TEL fluorescent lamps, nondimmable (TRIDONIC.ATCO PC PRO series)
C10 1.5 mm2 48 32 46 32 48 32 46 32 48 48 34 22 34 22/14 34 14 C13 1.5 mm2 72 44 70 44 72 44 70 44 72 72 46 32 46 32/18 46 18 C16 1.5 mm2 80 54 78 52 80 54 78 52 80 80 74 38 74 38/22 74 22 C20 B10 2.5 1.5 2 mm mm2 100 24 64 16 98 23 60 16 100 24 64 16 98 23 60 16 100 24 100 24 84 17 44 11 84 17 44/30 11/7 84 17 30 7 B13 B16 B20 1.5 1.5 2.5 2 2 mm mm mm2 36 40 50 22 27 32 35 39 49 22 26 30 36 40 50 22 27 32 35 39 49 22 26 30 36 40 50 36 40 50 23 37 42 16 19 22 23 37 42 16/9 19/11 22/15 23 37 42 9 11 15

1/9 W TC-SEL 2/9 W TC-SEL 1/10 W TC-DEL 2/10 W TC-DEL 1/11 W TC-SEL 2/11 W TC-SEL 1/13 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/13 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/18 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/18 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/26 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/26 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/32 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/32 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/42 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/42 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL

Electronic ballasts for TC-DEL/TEL compact fluorescent lamps, Basic dimming/Dali dimming (TRIDONIC.ATCO PCA TCD/TCT ECO/EXCEL one4all series)
C10 C13 1.5 1.5 mm2 mm2 40 60 28 40 40 60 28 40 30 50 22 32 30 50 22 32 26 38 10 18 26 38 12 18 12 16 C16 C20 1.5 2.5 mm2 mm2 80 80 60 64 80 80 60 64 70 76 46 68 70 76 46 56 50 58 24 28 50 58 24 28 22 26 B10 1.5 mm2 20 14 20 14 15 11 15 11 13 5 13 6 6 B13 1.5 mm2 30 20 30 20 25 15 25 16 19 9 19 9 8 B16 1.5 mm2 40 30 40 30 35 23 35 23 25 12 25 12 11 B20 2.5 mm2 40 32 40 32 38 34 38 28 29 14 29 14 13

1/11 W TC-SEL 2/11 W TC-SEL 1/13 W TC-DEL 2/13 W TC-DEL 1/18 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/18 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/26 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/26 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/32 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/32 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/42 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 2/42 W TC-DEL/TC-TEL 1/57 W TC-TEL The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 21

Loading of automatic circuit breakers for high-pressure lamps Maximum recommended number of ballasts per automatic circuit breaker Conventional ballasts for metal halide lamps, uncompensated
Lamp values W A 35 0.53 70 0.98 150 1.8 250 3 400 3.5* 400 4.4** Number of ballasts per automatic circuit breaker C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 B16 B20 B25 11 18 23 29 9 15 18 23 7 11 14 17 5 8 9 12 4 6 7 9 2 4 5 6 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 2 3 4 5 1 2 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 1 2 2

* with OGLI 400 ... ballast and lamp current of approx. 3.5 A ** with OGLS 400 ... ballast and lamp current of approx. 4.4 A

Conventional ballasts for high-pressure sodium vapour lamps, uncompensated


Lamp values W A 50 0.77 70 1 100 1.2 150 1.8 250 3 400 4.4 Number of ballasts per automatic circuit breaker C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 B16 B20 9 14 18 22 6 10 13 7 11 14 17 5 8 10 6 9 11 14 4 6 8 4 6 7 9 2 4 5 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 1 2 B25 16 12 10 7 4 2

Conventional ballasts for high-pressure mercury vapour lamps, uncompensated


Lamp values W A 50 0.6 80 0.8 125 1.15 250 2.15 400 3.25 700 5.4 Number of ballasts per automatic C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 10 15 18 23 8 6 9 11 14 6 4 7 7 9 4 2 3 3 4 2 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 circuit breaker B16 B20 B25 13 16 20 10 12 15 7 9 10 3 4 5 2 3 3 1 1 1

22 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Conventional ballasts for metal halide lamps, compensated


Lamp values W A 35 0.53 70 0.98 150 1.8 250 3 400 3.5* 400 4.4** ComNumber of ballasts per automatic pensation C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 6 22 36 45 50 11 12 12 18 23 29 8 20 7 11 14 17 5 32 5 7 9 11 3 35 3 5 7 8 2 45 3 4 5 7 2 circuit breaker B16 18 13 8 5 4 3 B20 23 16 10 6 5 4 B25 27 20 12 8 6 5

* with OGLI 400 ... ballast and lamp current of approx. 3.5 A ** with OGLS 400 ... ballast and lamp current of approx. 4.4 A

Conventional ballasts for high-pressure sodium vapour lamps, compensated


Lamp values W A 50 0.77 70 1 100 1.2 150 1.8 250 3 400 4.4 ComNumber of ballasts per automatic circuit breaker pensation C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 B16 B20 10 16 24 31 38 11 17 22 12 12 18 23 29 8 13 16 12 10 16 20 25 7 11 14 20 7 11 14 17 5 8 10 36 5 7 9 11 3 5 6 45 3 4 5 7 2 3 4

B25 27 20 17 12 8 5

Conventional ballasts for high-pressure mercury vapour lamps, compensated


Lamp values W A 50 0.6 80 0.8 125 1.15 250 2.15 400 3.25 700 5.4 ComNumber of ballasts per automatic circuit breaker pensation C10 C16 C20 C25 B10 B16 B20 B25 7 19 31 39 49 10 15 18 23 8 12 19 24 30 6 9 11 14 10 7 12 15 19 4 6 7 9 18 4 6 7 9 2 3 3 4 25 2 4 5 6 1 2 2 2 40 1 2 2 3 1 1 1

All data refer to a rated voltage of 230 V 50 Hz.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 23

Loading of automatic circuit breakers for low-voltage halogen incandescent lamps Maximum recommended number of transformers per automatic circuit breaker Magnetic transformers for QT/QR/QR-CB(C) halogen incandescent lamps (TRIDONIC.ATCO TMBx/OMTx series)
Power 20 W 35 W 50 W 70 W 80 W 105 W 150 W 210 W 300 W C10 58 41 21 15 14 8 4 23 12 C16 93 65 35 24 22 13 6 45 23 B10 29 20 10 7 7 4 2 1 n.r. B16 46 32 17 12 11 6 3 2 1

n.r. = not recommended

Magnetic transformers for QT/QR/QR-CB(C) halogen incandescent lamps (TRIDONIC.ATCO TMAx/TMDx series)
Power 20 W 35 W 40 W 50 W 60 W 70 W 80 W 105 W C10 42 35 26 23 21 16 13 9 C16 67 56 43 37 33 26 21 14 B10 21 17 13 11 10 8 6 4 B16 33 28 21 18 16 13 10 7

Magnetic transformers for QT/QR/QR-CB(C) halogen incandescent lamps (TRIDONIC.ATCO OGT series)
Power 250 W 300 W 500 W C10 34 2 1 C16 56 34 12 B10 12 1 n.r. B16 23 12 n.r.

n.r. = not recommended


Because of the high starting current of halogen incandescent lamps, we recommend to use automatic circuit breakers with C characteristics.

24 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Low-voltage installation
Service life and luminous flux The service life and luminous flux of low-voltage halogen lamps are extremely voltage dependent. Voltage changes on the line side are transferred to the secondary side in the same ratio.
50

Multiplication factor for relative operating values

30 20 10 8 6 4 2

Lh

1=
100 % 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.15 60 % 80 % 100 % 120 %

A 1 V overvoltage is insignificant for a 230 W halogen 4 lamp. For a 12 V halogen lamp, 3 however, this represents an 2 overvoltage of 8 % which re1 = duces the average 100% service life of the 0.8 0.6 halogen lamp, e.g. 0.4 from 3,000 hours 0.3 to approx. 1,200 0.2 hours.
7 6 5 0.1 0.08 0.06 0.04 0.03 0.02

Lh
140 %

= luminous flux Lh = service life

Voltage as % of nominal voltage

Operation at rated load Magnetic transformers should be operated at rated load as far as possible so as to avoid any rise in the secondary voltage which can result in a reduction in lamp service life (5 % overvoltage corresponds to 30 % shorter life). Conductor cross-sections and voltage drop Because the voltages are small, large currents flow on the secondary side. If conductors are long and have small crosssections, this can result in considerable voltage drops. Crosssections must be chosen so that the voltage drop across the conductor between transformer and lamp does not exceed 5 %.
The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 25

Required conductor cross-sections in mm2 as a function of transformer rating and cable length (one-way line length) for magnetic transformers:
Transformer rating Cable length in m

up to 2 m up to 4 m 20 VA 1.5 1.5 50 VA 1.5 1.5 1OO VA 1.5 2.5 150 VA 2.5 4 200 VA 4 4

up to 6 m 1.5 1.5 4 6 6

up to 8 m 1.5 2.5 4 6 10

up to 10 m up to 12 m 1.5 1.5 2.5 4 6 6 10 10 10 16

Installation The distance between transformer and lamps must be as short as possible (minimum distance, however, is approx. 30 cm) in order to avoid the relatively large conductor cross-sections. On the other hand, there is often unwanted humming, especially when lighting is adjusted; therefore the transformer must be installed out of earshot if possible.

Transformer

Wherever possible, cables must be laid in a star configuration and be of equal length to ensure that all lamps receive the same voltage.

26 / Chapter 7

The Lighting Handbook

Transformers and light regulation Only approved safety transformers should be used. The ambient temperature must not exceed 50 C max. Please note that transformers for use in areas which present fire risks must carry the appropriate conformity mark (e.g. , , , ). Phase control Halogen lamps are operated with a magnetic transformer. Reverse phase control Halogen lamps are operated with an electronic transformer in the high-frequency range. Important: do not exceed maximum conductor length. Safety measures when operating low-voltage halogen lamps Low-voltage halogen lamps generate a huge amount of heat. In the case of recessed luminaires, make sure there is adequate heat removal and that the safety distances from combustible materials are observed. The necessary safety distances from the illuminated surface also apply when using spotlights. These are identified by the following symbol and details of the relevant distance in metres:

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 7 / 27

Chapter 8

Checklists
The five steps of lighting design. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checklist according to the five steps of lighting design. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance of lighting systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Environmental conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lamp lumens maintenance factor (LLMF) and lamp survival factor (LSF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table for luminaire maintenance factor (LMF) . . . . . . Table for room surface maintenance factor (RSMF) . . . Economic efficiency calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Economic analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of burning hours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Refurbishment of lighting systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Data collection sheet for lighting refurbishment . . . . . Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 11 4 11 12 19 13 14 17 18 19 20 23 21 22 23 24 28 27 28 29 33

The Lighting Handbook

The five steps of lighting design = help for structuring the lighting design scheme Determine lighting REQUIREMENTS SELECT lamps, luminaires and lighting management Calculate NUMBER of luminaires required POSITION luminaires and lighting control ANALYSE the results
From experience we know that usually Step 1 = Determine lighting requirements is not taken into account sufficiently. The checklist below should help the user to consider key questions for clarifying basic requirements. Accordingly, requirements are broken down as follows: General conditions Lighting quality requirements visual performance vista visual comfort vitality empowerment The lighting quality criteria are in line with those set by the EU. ELI (Ergonomic Lighting Indicator) was developed in collaboration with ETH Zurich and TU Ilmenau (Prof. Dr. Schierz). Understanding this task will allow for proper development of a well thought-out lighting solution based on the quality characteristics of lighting (Chapter 1) and project-specific requirements. Analysis includes the assessment of lighting quality. In the process, the requirement criteria are taken into account. The formulations for assessment differ from the requirements (ELI assessment).
The Lighting Handbook

A checklist for workplace analysis (page 11) is provided for easy identification of technical lighting equipment at workplaces, in particular DSE workstations. Chapter 8 / 3

Checklist according to the five steps of lighting design


1. Lighting requirements General conditions Utilization of room Size and height of room Ceiling structure Reflection factors Window areas Doors, passageways, circulation areas Multi-task areas Arrangement and material of furniture Protection types (foreign bodies and humidity) Protection classes (electrical installations) Influence by chemicals Fire protection Emergency lighting Energy consumption limits (kWh/year) Maximum power requirement (W/m) Budget for initial installation Lighting quality requirements (ELI requirements) Criterion A Visual performance
How well should the visual task be recognised? Explanation: Lighting in conformity with relevant standards is decisive for ensuring that the visual task can be identified and the related activities can be carried out. Consideration of the traditional quality characteristics of lighting has a major impact on visual task performance.

Checked

At the workstations, ... standard visual tasks have to be performed. ... visual tasks are the same across the whole area. ... colour distinction is required to a common extent. ... no extraordinary changes of viewing direction occur. 4 / Chapter 8
-2 -1 0* 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2

-2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2

The Lighting Handbook

Within the visual task area, ... hard shadows must be avoided. ... the field of vision should be free from sources of glare. ... reflections must be avoided.
* Minimum criterion, corresponds to values specified in the standards -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 Mean value Visual task

Criterion B Vista
How do you want to experience the lighting solution in your environment? Explanation: In prestigious buildings, for example, light is not only needed for seeing but also enhances the looks of the interior. Light can provide guidance and create a favourable first visual impression of a room.

In the project planned, ... ... the lighting concept should blend in smoothly with the interior design. ... the lighting concept should be properly geared towards expectations. ... the lighting concept should facilitate orientation in the room. In the project planned, ... ... the first visual impression will be decisive. ... the perceptible quality of the luminaire will be of major importance. ... the cleanliness of the room and the lighting will be of major importance.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Vista

Criterion C Visual comfort


How much visual comfort is required in the room? Explanation: Light is needed not only in the visual task area, but also for perception in the room. Rooms should be illuminated with uniform brightness and lighting balance.

In the project planned, ... ... users must be particularly protected from annoying sources of glare.
The Lighting Handbook
-2 -1 0 * 1 2

... it will be particularly important to identify three-dimensional structures in the room. ... the room should provide a bright and inviting impression.

-2 -1 0 1 2

-2 -1 0 1 2

Chapter 8 / 5

... daylight must be taken into account. ... there must be no flickering light. ... larger dark areas should be avoided. In the area around the visual task, the room should be illuminated uniformly.
* Minimum criterion, corresponds to values specified in the standards

-2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2

Mean value Visual comfort

Criterion D Vitality
How positive should the lights influence be on people? Explanation: Light significantly influences peoples activity and sense of well-being. Moreover, it has a positive impact on their health and may even enhance or influence biological processes.

The lighting concept ... should make people feel good. ... should stimulate people. In the project planned, ... ... it should be possible in particular to adjust the lighting to the brightness level required. ... the effect to be created should be as natural as possible. ... peoples circadian rhythm should be particularly taken into account. In the project planned, special emphasis is put on protection against sources of annoyance or adverse health effects.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Vitality

Criterion E Empowerment
To what extent should the lighting adjust to my personal requirements? Explanation: Varying visual requirements, visual tasks or periods of use call for options to individually influence ones lighting situation. Sensors and control systems help users adjust the lighting situation to their personal needs.

In the project planned, ... ... the user should be able to personally influence the lighting situation. ... a variety of tasks must be taken into account. The lighting should be switched automatically. The artificial lighting should be controlled by daylight sensors. 6 / Chapter 8
1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

The Lighting Handbook

1 2 3 4 5

The lighting should be controlled on the basis of time. Any future layout changes should be taken into account.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely

1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Empowerment

ELI LENI requirements


Application: the mean values of the individual criteria are entered on the centre lines of the spider chart.

Visual performance

1 0 5

E
Empowerment

-1 2 1 -2 1 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 2 3

5B Vista

3 4 5

D
Vitality

C
Visual comfort

ELI

60

120

0
kWh/m a
2

180

LENI Calculation see Chapter 1 / 19

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 8 / 7

2. Selection of lamps, luminaires and lighting management Lamp type Luminaire range and model Lighting management range and modules 3. Calculate number of luminaires required Rough calculation (Quickplan/Quickcalc) Detailed calculation (Dialux/Relux) Planning conditions (maintenance, reflection) 4. Positioning of luminaires and lighting control Positioning the luminaires structural situation orientation (avoid reflections and glare) spacings between luminaires (regular patterns) peripheries alignment techn. infrastructure (distribution cabinet, clamping compartment, ) Position of control gear Emergency lighting 5. Analysis of results Lighting quality analysis (ELI assessment) Criterion A Visual performance
How well can the visual task be recognised?

Checked

Explanation: Lighting in conformity with relevant standards is decisive for ensuring that the visual task can be identified and the related activities can be carried out. Consideration of the traditional quality characteristics of lighting has a major impact on visual task performance.

In the main visual task area, the lighting ... provides uniformity of illuminance. ... complies with the colour rendition index. 8 / Chapter 8
-2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2

The Lighting Handbook

... complies with the maintenance value of illuminance.

-2 -1 0 * 1 2

In the area around the visual task, the illuminance level required is achieved. In the lighting installation as it exists at present, ... annoying hard shadows, ... irritating direct glare ... and annoying reflections are avoided.
* Minimum criterion, corresponds to values specified in the standards

-2 -1 0 1 2

-2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 Mean value Visual task

Please note: EN 12464 specifies standard values; values may be lower only if visual tasks are modified. Where there are several task areas, calculate and assess the mean value for all of them.

Criterion B Vista
How do you experience the lighting solution in your environment? Explanation: In prestigious buildings, for example, light is not only needed for seeing but also enhances the looks of the interior. Light can provide guidance and create a favourable first visual impression of a room.

The lighting concept ... enhances interior design features. ... fulfils my personal expectations. ... takes passageways, circulation areas and activity zones into consideration. ... creates a hierarchy of perception (lighting focuses). The luminaires make a high-quality impression. The luminaires are neither soiled nor affected by other foreign substances.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Vista

Criterion C Visual comfort


How much visual comfort is provided in the room? Explanation: Light is needed not only in the visual task area, but also for perception in the room. Rooms should be illuminated with uniform brightness and lighting balance. -2 -1 0 * 1 2

The lighting solution produces no glare (UGR).


The Lighting Handbook

The lighting components are balanced and matched to the room. The ceiling and walls are pleasantly bright.

-2 -1 0 1 2

-2 -1 0 1 2

Chapter 8 / 9

The lighting solution ... takes daylight into account and uses it. ... does not flicker. ... does not allow major dark areas in the room. The task area environment is uniformly illuminated.
* Minimum criterion, corresponds to values specified in the standards -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2

Mean value Visual comfort

Criterion D Vitality
How positive is the lights influence on the people? Explanation: Light significantly influences peoples activity and sense of well-being. Moreover, it has a positive impact on their health and may even enhance or influence biological processes.

The lighting ... is one of the factors that make me feel good. ... has a stimulating effect. ... adjusts to the brightness level required. The lighting creates a natural, pleasant effect. The lighting stabilises/enhances the users circadian rhythm. There are no sources of annoyance or adverse health effects.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Vitality

Criterion E Empowerment
To what extent does the lighting adjust to my personal requirements? Explanation: Varying visual requirements, visual tasks or periods of use call for options to individually influence ones lighting situation. Sensors and control systems help users adjust the lighting situation to their personal needs. 1 2 3 4 5

The installation can be switched or dimmed. A variety of lighting scenes can be called up.

1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

Presence detectors make sure that the lighting switches automatically. Thanks to daylight sensors, the artificial lighting adjusts to daylight changes over the course of the day. Automated, dynamic scenes are available. 10 / Chapter 8

1 2 3 4 5

1 2 3 4 5

The Lighting Handbook

Luminaires and switches can be rearranged flexibly. The luminaires are arranged so as to allow for flexible change in room utilisation without major effort.
1 = does not apply at all; 5 = applies completely

1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5

Mean value Empowerment

ELI LENI assessments


Application: the mean values of the individual criteria are entered on the centre lines of the spider chart.
Visual performance

1 0 5

E
Empowerment

-1 2 1 -2 1 1 2 -2 -1 0 1 2 2 3

5B Vista

3 4 5

D
Vitality

C
Visual comfort

ELI 60 120

0
kWh/m2 a

180

LENI Calculation see Chapter 1 / 19 Other analyses Situation regarding standards Economic efficiency
The Lighting Handbook

Budget Documentation Methods of presentation Chapter 8 / 11

Maintenance of lighting systems


Today, the maintenance of lighting installations is a decisive factor in an installations balance of costs. According to the formula below (1), a lighting level required of Em = 500 lx at a standard maintenance factor of MF = 0.67 implies a new illuminance level of Enew = 750 lx. Em: maintained illuminance = maintenance value of illuminance (1) Em = Enew x MF (maintenance factor) Benefit of a high MF: lower luminaire investment costs reduced energy costs Benefit of a low MF: low maintenance costs longer maintenance intervals

Please note: at a lower maintenance factor, illuminance may be constantly dimmed to the maintenance value to save energy (maintenance control). The maintenance factor includes 4 components: (2) MF = LLMF x LSF x LMF x RMF All these factors describe the decrease in illuminance. The maximum in each case is 1, corresponding to the new value. At the respective time of maintenance, the various causes of the decrease in illuminance must be identified.
Maintenance factor components Causes of illuminance decrease

Lamp luminous flux mainten. factor LLMF Lamp survival factor LSF Luminaire maintenance factor LMF Room maintenance factor RMF

Ageing of lamps Failure of lamps Soiling of luminaire Soiling of room

12 / Chapter 8

The Lighting Handbook

Options for improving the maintenance factor: Lamp replacement already before the lamp service life ends (LLWF/LSF ) Immediate replacement of lamps in case of failure (LSF = 1) Use of closed luminaires (LWF7 ) More frequent room cleaning (RWF7 )

160 % 140 % 120 % 100 % 80 % 60 % 40 % 20 % 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 years 2.5 3.0

Example: Luminaire maintenance: every year Room surface maintenance: every 3 years Lamp replacement: every 3 years Faulty lamp replacement: immediately

= Enew = Em 3.5

Environmental conditions
In case you are not familiar with the application, the following standard values apply; however, the tables below will help you calculate the accurate maintenance factor according to formula (2).
Ambient condition Very Clean Maintenance Working interval areas recommended Clean-rooms, data 3 years centres, assembly workstations for electronic components 3 years 2 years Offices, schools Shops, laboratories, restaurants, warehouses, assembly bays Steel works, chemical plants, foundries, welding shops, grinding shops, wood processing Reference maintenance factor 0.80

Clean Normal

0.67 0.57

Soiled

1 year

0.50

The Lighting Handbook

According to CIE volume 97, Maintenance of indoor electric lighting systems, at 2005

Chapter 8 / 13

Lamp lumens maintenance factor (LLMF)

14 / Chapter 8

Lamps

Incandescent lamp CIE97:2005 Halogen incandescent lamp CIE97:2005 T26 (low-loss ballast) single-band fluorescent lamp ZVEI 2005 T26 (low-loss ballast) triple-band fluorescent lamp ZVEI 2005 T26 (electronic ballast) triple-band fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005/CIE97:2005 T26 (el. ball.) triple-band fluor. lamp, long-life Philips MASTER TL-D Xtreme (long life) T26 (el. ball.) triple-band fluor. lamp, long-life AURA Ultimate LL (long life) T16 (electronic ballast) triple-band fluorescent lamp ZVEI 2005 T16 (el. ball.) triple-band fluor. lamp, long-life AURA SUPREME T5 HO LL (long life)

LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF

Burning hours 100 500 1,000 1,500 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000 10,000 12,000 14,000 16,000 18,000 20,000 22,000 24,000 30,000 35,000 40,000 45,000 1.00 0.97 0.93 1.00 0.98 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.97 0.95 1.00 1.00 0.78 0.50 1.00 0.97 0.94 0.91 0.89 0.82 0.78 0.76 0.73 0.72 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.96 0.94 0.90 0.78 0.60 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.91 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.93 0.83 0.60 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.90 0.75 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.95 0.94 0.94 0.93 0.93 0.93 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.98 0.90 0.70 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.95 0.94 0.94 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.91 0.91 0.91 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.89 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.96 0.91 0.80 0.50 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.89 0.89 0.88 0.88 0.88 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.98

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

and lamp survival factor (LSF)

Compact fluorescent lamp CIE97:2005 TC-S, TC-D, TC-T 5-26W (low-loss ballast) Compact fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005 TC-SEL, TC-TEL 5-42W (electronic ballast) Compact fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005 TC-DEL 10-26W (electronic ballast) Compact fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005 TC-L 18-36W (low-loss ballast) Compact fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005 TC-L 18-80W (electronic ballast) Compact fluor. lamp ZVEI 2005 Induction lamp Philips QL

LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF

1.00 0.98 0.97 0.94 0.91 0.89 0.87 0.85 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.94 0.86 0.50 1.00 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.93 0.86 0.83 0.80 0.78 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.81 0.60 1.00 0.98 0.96 0.94 0.93 0.87 0.84 0.82 0.80 0.79 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.93 0.76 0.55 1.00 0.98 0.96 0.94 0.92 0.87 0.85 0.82 0.80 0.79 0.78 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.91 0.80 0.60 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.92 0.90 0.89 0.88 0.88 0.88 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.95 0.86 0.62 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.94 0.93 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.89 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.96 0.95 0.90 0.75 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.94 0.92 0.89 0.88 0.87 0.86 0.86 0.85 0.84 0.83 0.83 0.81 0.79 0.77 0.75 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.94

Chapter 8 / 15

Values acc. to specications by lamp manufacturers, January 2008, acc. to CIE97:2005 Technical report Guide on the Maintenance of Indoor Electric Lighting Systems 2nd edition, and ZVEI publication Service life behaviour of discharge lamps for lighting of November 2005. For data of lamps by other manufacturers or other lamp types, please contact the respective manufacturer directly. The use of state-of-the-art ballast technology is a prerequisite. The switching frequency has a major inuence on lamp survival. Most data are based on the standardised 3-hour switching rhythm acc. to IEC (2.75 h ON, 0.25 h OFF).

Lamp lumens maintenance factor (LLMF)

16 / Chapter 8

Lamps

Metal halide lamp Ceramic (50-150W) CIE97:2005 Metal halide lamp Ceramic Philips CDM-T 70W/Elite Metal halide lamp Ceramic Osram HCI-T 150W/WDL PB Metal halide lamp Ceramic Osram HCI 250W PB Metal halide lamp Quartz (250/400W) CIE97:2005 Metal halide lamp Quartz Osram HQI-E 250W/D Metal halide lamp Quartz Osram HQI-E 400W/D Metal halide lamp Quartz Osram HQI-BT 400W/N Metal halide lamp Quartz Philips HPI-T Plus 250/400W

LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF

Burning hours 100 500 1,000 1,500 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000 10,000 12,000 14,000 16,000 18,000 20,000 22,000 24,000 30,000 35,000 40,000 45,000 1.00 0.95 0.87 0.75 0.72 0.68 0.64 0.60 0.56 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.98 0.95 0.80 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.96 0.95 0.91 0.87 0.85 0.81 0.80 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.98 0.90 0.50 1.00 0.93 0.88 0.87 0.86 0.80 0.77 0.73 0.71 0.69 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.96 0.88 0.70 1.00 0.96 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.87 0.84 0.81 0.80 0.75 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.94 0.90 0.85 0.75 0.62 1.00 0.98 0.95 0.90 0.87 0.83 0.79 0.65 0.63 0.60 0.56 0.53 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.92 0.86 0.80 0.73 0.68 0.63 0.55 0.50 0.99 0.98 0.92 0.88 0.85 0.80 0.75 0.70 0.69 0.65 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.91 0.86 0.79 0.70 0.61 1.00 0.97 0.93 0.88 0.85 0.80 0.78 0.74 0.71 0.69 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.91 0.86 0.79 0.70 0.61 1.00 0.97 0.92 0.87 0.83 0.77 0.73 0.72 0.70 0.69 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.95 0.91 0.86 0.79 0.70 0.61 1.00 0.98 0.96 0.93 0.92 0.86 0.83 0.80 0.78 0.76 0.74 0.73 0.72 0.71 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.96 0.93 0.89 0.84 0.75 0.66 0.59 0.50

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF LSF LLMF

1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.91 0.87 0.83 0.81 0.79 0.77 0.75 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.94 0.91 0.84 0.77 0.63 0.50 1.00 0.98 0.94 0.91 0.87 0.80 0.77 0.75 0.73 0.72 0.71 0.70 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.93 0.88 0.83 0.72 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.93 0.90 0.89 0.88 0.88 0.87 0.87 0.87 0.86 0.85 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.93 0.92 0.89 0.84 0.79 0.72 0.63 0.50 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.93 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.89 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.87 0.87

and lamp survival factor (LSF)

High-pressure mercury-vapour lamp 501,000W ZVEI 2005 Mercury vapour lamp Philips HPL-N 50-400W Sodium vapour lamp 50/70W ZVEI 2005 Sodium vapour lamp 150400W (standard luminous flux) ZVEI 2005 Sodium vapour lamp 150400W (higher luminous flux) ZVEI 2005 Sodium vapour lamp Philips SON(-T) PIA Plus 100400W

LSF 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.93 0.92 0.90 0.88 0.84 0.79 0.70 LLMF 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.91 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90

LSF 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.95 0.93 0.92 0.90 0.86 0.81 0.73 LLMF 1.00 0.99 0.99 0.98 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.95 0.94 0.94 0.93 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.90 0.89 LSF 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 0.99 0.98 0.97 0.96 0.93 0.92 0.88 0.86 0.82 0.77 0.55 0.43

Chapter 8 / 17

Values acc. to specications by lamp manufacturers, January 2008, acc. to CIE97:2005 Technical report Guide on the Maintenance of Indoor Electric Lighting Systems 2nd edition, and ZVEI publication Service life behaviour of discharge lamps for lighting of November 2005. For data of lamps by other manufacturers or other lamp types, please contact the respective manufacturer directly. The use of state-of-the-art ballast technology is a prerequisite. The switching frequency has a major inuence on lamp survival. Most data are based on the standardised 3-hour switching rhythm acc. to IEC (2.75 h ON, 0.25 h OFF).

Table for luminaire maintenance factor (LMF)

18 / Chapter 8
2.0 V SS S N V SS V 2.5 V SS S N 3.0 S N

0.5 SS S N

V SS

1.0 S N

V SS

1.5 S N

Luminaire cleaning interval in years Environment type Luminaire type Bare batten luminaires

0.98 0.95 0.92 0.88 0.96 0.93 0.89 0.83 0.95 0.91 0.87 0.80 0.94 0.89 0.84 0.78 0.93 0.87 0.82 0.75 0.92 0.85 0.79 0.73

Reflector exposed above (self-cleaning effect)

0.96 0.95 0.91 0.88 0.95 0.90 0.86 0.83 0.94 0.87 0.83 0.79 0.92 0.84 0.80 0.75 0.91 0.82 0.76 0.71 0.89 0.79 0.74 0.68

Reflector enclosed above (no self-cleaning effect)

0.95 0.93 0.89 0.83 0.94 0.89 0.81 0.72 0.93 0.84 0.74 0.64 0.91 0.80 0.69 0.59 0.89 0.77 0.64 0.54 0.87 0.74 0.61 0.52

Enclosed IP2X

0.94 0.92 0.87 0.83 0.94 0.88 0.82 0.77 0.93 0.85 0.79 0.73 0.91 0.83 0.77 0.71 0.90 0.81 0.75 0.68 0.89 0.79 0.73 0.65

Dust-proof IP5X

0.94 0.96 0.93 0.91 0.96 0.94 0.90 0.86 0.92 0.92 0.88 0.83 0.93 0.91 0.86 0.81 0.92 0.90 0.85 0.80 0.92 0.90 0.84 0.79

Indirect luminaires 0.94 0.92 0.89 0.85 0.93 0.86 0.81 0.74 0.91 0.81 0.73 0.65 0.77 0.88 0.66 0.57 0.86 0.73 0.60 0.51 0.85 0.70 0.55 0.45 From CIE publication 97 Maintenance of indoor electric lighting systems, dated 2005, ISBN 3 900 734 34 8 Ambient conditions: SS = very clean (sehr sauber), S = clean (sauber), N = normal, V = soiled (verschmutzt)

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

5.0

5.5

6.0

Table for room surface maintenance factor (RSMF)

Room cleaning interval in years 0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 Illumina- Environment tion type type Direct SS 1.00 0.98 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.97 0.97 S 1.00 0.96 0.95 0.94 0.94 0.94 0.94 0.94 0.94 0.94 N 1.00 0.92 0.91 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 0.90 V 1.00 0.87 0.86 0.86 0.86 0.86 0.86 0.86 0.86 0.86 Direct/ SS 1.00 0.97 0.96 0.95 0.95 0.95 0.95 0.95 0.95 0.95 Indirect S 1.00 0.93 0.91 0.91 0.91 0.91 0.91 0.91 0.91 0.91 N 1.00 0.87 0.84 0.84 0.83 0.83 0.83 0.83 0.83 0.83 V 1.00 0.77 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 Indirect SS 1.00 0.95 0.93 0.92 0.92 0.92 0.92 0.92 0.92 0.92 S 1.00 0.89 0.86 0.85 0.85 0.84 0.84 0.84 0.84 0.84 N 1.00 0.77 0.73 0.72 0.72 0.72 0.72 0.72 0.72 0.72 V 1.00 0.60 0.56 0.55 0.55 0.55 0.55 0.55 0.55 0.55 From CIE publication 97 Maintenance of indoor electric lighting systems, dated 2005, ISBN 3 900 734 34 8 The figures in the table above apply to reflection factors 70/50/20 and a medium-sized room (k = 2.5) Ambient conditions: SS = very clean (sehr sauber), S = clean (sauber), N = normal, V = soiled (verschmutzt) 0.97 0.94 0.90 0.86 0.95 0.91 0.83 0.75 0.92 0.84 0.72 0.55 0.97 0.94 0.90 0.86 0.95 0.91 0.83 0.75 0.92 0.84 0.72 0.55 0.97 0.94 0.90 0.86 0.95 0.91 0.83 0.75 0.92 0.84 0.72 0.55

Chapter 8 / 19

Economic efficiency calculation


A short pay-back period is usually the most important consideration when designing lighting systems. The pay-back period calculation using the following forms is based on a static calculation method. This is a theoretical approach that delivers a guide value very quickly and is perfectly adequate for an initial estimate. Dynamic calculation models involving depreciation and interest payments are left to the financial experts and fall outside the scope of this handbook. Static calculation model Pay-back time = Extra expenditure investment costs Annual saving in operating costs

20 / Chapter 8

The Lighting Handbook

Definition of terms used in the economic analysis sheets (3) System power of luminaire Lamp wattage + power dissipation in control gear. (5) Annual burning hours Total of the daily lamp ON hours over the year. The table of burning hours (Chap. 8/25) provides help for daylight-based systems. (9) Maintenance factor A reference maintenance factor of 0.67 can be assumed (3-year maintenance interval, clean environment), e.g. office; see Chap. 8/15). The maintenance value can be determined precisely on the basis of the details included in the previous chapter Maintenance of lighting installations. The lighting calculation cannot be made until the maintenance factor has been determined. The maintenance factor plus the general conditions have to be documented in the design process. (14) Cost of lamp replacement Cost of the complete job of replacing the lamps, including the costs of the lamp and additional costs such as step ladders, weekend overtime payments or loss of production. (15) Cost of luminaire cleaning Cost of the complete job of cleaning the luminaire plus replacing faulty components in the lighting system including parts costs. (16) Cost of room cleaning Labour costs for cleaning room surfaces and restoring the reflection characteristics to their new condition. (17) Energy costs per kWh Estimate a mixed price for high and low tariff. Include energy standing charges in the working price.

Economic analysis
Building project

Option 1 Luminaire type Luminaire data Number of lamps per luminaire System power of luminaire (W) Operating data Service life of system (y) Annual burning hours see Chap. 8/25 Lamp replacement interval (y) Luminaire cleaning interval (y) Room cleaning interval (y) Number of luminaires Maintenance factor Number of luminaires Itemised investment costs Cost of one luminaire Cost of one lamp
The Lighting Handbook
(11) (12) (13) (9) (10) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (2) (3) (1)

Option 2

Installation costs per luminaire

Chapter 8 / 21

Option 1 Itemised operating costs Cost of lamp replacement Cost of luminaire cleaning Cost of room cleaning Energy costs per kWh Investment costs Luminaire costs (10) x (11) Lamp costs (10) x (2) x (12) Installation costs (10) x (13) Investment costs (18) + (19) + (20) Operating costs Lamp replacement costs (14) x (4) Luminaire cleaning costs (15) x (4) Room cleaning costs (16) x (4) Energy costs (10) x (3) x (4) x (5) x (17)
(7) (6) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26) (27) (18) (19) (20) (21) (14) (15) (16) (17)

Option 2

(8) 1000

Operating costs (22) + (23) + (24) + (25) Annual operating costs (26)
(4)

Pay-back period* =

(21) Option 2 (21) Option 1 (27) Option 1 (27) Option 2

years

Pay-back period* =
* excludes depreciation and interest

years
The Lighting Handbook

22 / Chapter 8

The Lighting Handbook

Working mode/shift type

Daylight-based control

24-h shift working, Process monitoring/control 4,960 3,720 3,100 1,760 2,580 1,550

On period Days in use/year 365 365

Hours/day 24 24

No Yes

Burning hours per lamp and year in hours 8,760 7,300

Double shift, 6 days/week

310 310

16 16

No Yes

Table of burning hours

Single shift, 6 days/week

310 310

10 10

No Yes

Single shift, 5 days/week

258 258

10 10

No Yes

Daylight-based control: the lamps switch on automatically when there is too little daylight available. Data is based on the assumption that there is sufficient available daylight for half the year.

From CIE publication 97 Maintenance of indoor electric lighting systems, dated 2005

Chapter 8 / 23

Refurbishment of lighting systems


The following list provides clues for discussion with the customer. The potentialities stated draw a comparison between contemporary lighting solution options available today with the technology approx. 15 years ago. In a project, viable savings must be accurately calculated in the design stage. The savings apply only on a case-by-case basis. If several measures are taken, they will complement each other without the levels adding up. 1. Saving energy, CO2 and costs Pros 1. Advanced materials Todays reflectors and innovative surface finishes provide for more efficient luminaires (e.g. PSP+). 2. Use of daylight The Luxmate daylight-based lighting control system provides for high energy savings where sufficient daylight is available. 3. Improvement of lamps and control gear Innovations in the electronic control of lamps, optimised temperatures and improvements of the lamps physical properties provide for extensive savings. 4. Taking ageing into account The balance between the new value and minimum illuminance can be saved by dimmable control (Maintenance Control). 5. Taking room utilisation into account Using presence detectors or a time-based control system, the lighting can be adjusted more properly to the time/s of use. Potential savings up to 30 %

up to 60 %

up to 40 %

up to 17 %

up to 25 %

24 / Chapter 8

The Lighting Handbook

2. Improved ergonomic compatibility Pros 1. Increased productivity According to various studies, peoples productivity can be significantly improved by an upgraded lighting solution (e.g. research by TU Ilmenau, AIF no. 9955). 2. Fewer errors According to various studies, peoples error rate can be minimised by an upgraded lighting solution (e.g. research by TU Ilmenau, AIF no. 9955). 3. Increased alertness The human physiology is decoded step by step, allowing to perfectly adjust the lighting to the individual (e.g. doctoral thesis by Susanne Fleischer, ETH Zrich). 4. Enhanced sense of well-being Pleasant brightness levels and personal control can have a positive impact on peoples sense of well-being (e.g. Light Right Consortium). Potential savings

Please note: It is difficult to provide exact and generally applicable figures; however, measurable increases were achieved in individual cases. Minor increases already result in high economic benefits.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 8 / 25

3. Improved maintenance conditions (employment of staff for cleaning, maintenance and monitoring) Pros 1. Extension of maintenance cycle Over recent years, the service life of lamps has been significantly extended (e.g. Philips Master TL-D Xtreme, AURA Ultimate LL). 2. Reduction in maintenance costs up to 30 % Contemporary luminaires frequently come in a closed design, allowing for easy cleaning (e.g. MELLOW LIGHT IV, LIGHTFIELDS, PERLUCE). 3. Automatic monitoring of installations up to 80 % Today, facility management tools allow for automatic, central monitoring of installations (e.g. in emergency lighting/ONLITE). 4. Energy savings up to 20 % Easy cleaning of luminaires, and extension of the maintenance cycle result in a reduced number of luminaires required, and thus energy savings (e.g. TECTON I IP). 4. Additional pros Pros 1. Improvements in environmental factors Today, WEEE and RoHS provide the basis for manufacturing luminaires. Environmental impact has been reduced (e.g. lead/cadmium). 2. State of the art The latest lighting solutions reflect the state of the art and an improved situation in terms of lighting standards. Potential savings up to +50 %

Collecting data for lighting refurbishment


The Lighting Handbook

The following forms are intended to help you collect all relevant data required for evaluating the situation in terms of existing lighting installations. They provide the basis for comparing technical lighting features and for calculating costs.

26 / Chapter 8

Data collection sheet for lighting refurbishment


Project Address Activities in room Contact Tel Fax

Old system Option 1 Luminaire type A


Number of luminaires Number of lamps per luminaire Type of ballast System power per luminaire including ballast (W) Illuminance

Option 2

Luminaire type B
Number of luminaires Number of lamps per luminaire Type of ballast System power per luminaire including ballast (W) Illuminance

Total installed load in kW ON period each day (h) Working days per year Annual ON period (h) Power consumption in kWh/a

Annual savings in kWh


Basic power price kW/year
The Lighting Handbook

Power costs per kWh Annual power costs in kWh

Annual savings Chapter 8 / 27

Room length Room width Room height Uniformity Emean = Emin = lx lx

Reflection: wall ceiling floor u = Emin = Emean

% % %

Room sketch:

Cleaning per luminaire/year Lamp replacement (incl. lamp)

28 / Chapter 8

The Lighting Handbook

Costs

Old system Option 1

Option 2

The Lighting Handbook

1. Fundamental analysis in luminaires with electronic ballast or dimmable electronic ballast:


Note Checked

Error occurring

Possible cause

Possible solution

Luminaire was recently installed but cannot be switched on 230 V 10 % Power reset

Faulty circuit-breaker/mains fuse

After checking, perhaps install new circuit-breaker/fuse

Faulty cable leading to luminaire

Measure voltage at luminaire terminal Fix wiring at input end

Ballast power down

Use mains fuse to briefly switch off luminaire power, then switch on again

Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires

With 3~ through-wiring in particular, overvoltages (400 V) may have occurred. N conductor has been confused with L conductor directly earthed conductor interrupted unbalanced load

Visually check electronic ballasts if there are any burn marks at mains input. Replace all units affected.

Chapter 8 / 29

Error occurring Power reset

Possible cause

Possible solution

Note

Checked

Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires

30 / Chapter 8

Luminaire worked but suddenly cannot be switched on again

No re-ignition after lamp replacement

Use mains fuse to briefly switch off luminaire power, then switch on again

Faulty lamp

Check cause: replace lamp/s for working lamp/s from adjacent luminaire. Fit new lamp/s if cause has been confirmed. In multi-lamp luminaires, all lamps have to be replaced (make voltage reset)

Wrong lamp

Check compatibility with ballast. Details on ballast label must conform with details printed on lamp

Faulty lampholder contact

Check by rotating lamp several times to left and right (approx. 180)

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

2. Additional tests for luminaires with dimmable electronic ballast:


Note Power reset with switchdim Checked

Error occurring

Possible cause

Possible solution

Dimmable luminaire already worked but suddenly cannot be switched on again. Power reset with bus signal

Ballast power down in switchdim installations

Use mains fuse to briefly switch off power. Actuate momentary-action switch at switchdim input (switching on/off)

Ballast power down in LM and/or DALI bus installations

Intermit signal in bus line (B1, B2 or Dali) (disconnect line). Use mains fuse to briefly switch off power. Then reconnect bus line and try to switch luminaire via control gear installed (LM or Dali).

Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires

Problems with signal line and/or bus line (faulty bus)

Measure power at bus

Specified values: DALI: 9 to 15 V = LM: 13 to 15 V = DSI: no power measured

Chapter 8 / 31

3. Additional test for HID luminaires (high-pressure lamps such as HIT, HST, etc.):
Note Checked

Error occurring

Possible cause

Possible solution

Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires

32 / Chapter 8

After relamping, luminaire does not work any more.

No contact in lampholder thread

screw-fasten lamp as deeply as possible between lamp solder point and cap tab remove oxidation from lamp solder point, if necessary.

The Lighting Handbook

The Lighting Handbook

4. Analysis of partial function of luminaires with electronic ballast (bad lighting quality of fluorescent lamp):
Note Checked

Error occurring

Possible cause

Possible solution

Lamp start delayed

No earth connection in luminaires with protection class 1

Connect luminaire earth

Bad dimming quality

Bad earth connection

Use high-resistance voltmeter to measure power between phase and earth, and between neutral conductor and earth

Poor luminous efficiency/dimming behaviour

Ambient temperature of lamp too low/too high

Check for heat buildup underneath high Common ceilings or at workplaces with very high temperature range: temperatures. Too low temperatures outside, 15 C < T < 35 C or heavy air flow (e.g. air-conditioning system) Cool Spot

Analysis of malfunctions in luminaires

Cool spot neglected

Do not operate lamps in positions unprovided for

Chapter 8 / 33

Increasing migration of dark spots along fluorescent lamp

In order to achieve an appropriate lighting quality, new lamps should always be operated at 100% for the first 100 hours of operation

Chapter 9

Services
Design process and tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 ELI-LENI Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 VIVALDI Composing light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Online product information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 8 Product data sheets and installation instructions available online . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 CAD data in 2D and 3D available online . . . . . . . . . . 8 Online lighting design tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 10 ZUMTOBEL Lighting DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

Design process and tools


Design process: Communication Attention to/awareness of concepts and products Determine basic situation; define requirements Blueprint planning Work out a concept Optimise Detailed planning Calculation Documentation Implementation Testing Maintenance

Requirement

Design

Implementation

Design tools: Communication Product catalogue, brochures, ads and press work, trade fairs, congresses, events, roadshows, Light Forums ELI-LENI calculator Research projects, studies VIVALDI reference Library Online catalogue, QuickCalc, FluxCalc, system configurators, maintenance factor calculation, LM Energy VIVALDI visualisation, DIALux, Relux, ELI-LENI calculator, efficiency analysis, VIVALDI optimising

Requirement

Design

Implementation
The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 9 / 3

ELI-LENI calculator
Award your lighting solution a quality seal. The ELI-LENI calculator calculates energy consumption in a straightforward manner based on the provisions of EN 15193 (LENI). The five descriptive quality criteria of any lighting solution (visual performance, vista, visual comfort, vitality and empowerment) are evaluated within only a few minutes by means of a questionnaire (ELI). Further information and downloads at: www.zumtobel.com/humanergybalance

4 / Chapter 9

The Lighting Handbook

VIVALDI Composing light


The innovative software for Humanergy Balance lighting concepts makes energy efficiency and lighting quality visible and measurable. Optimised lighting solutions offering a balance between energy and ergonomics Interactive visual preparation of scene-based lighting concepts Dynamic visualisation of light including measurement of energy consumption as well as CO2 quantity Supports the design process in combination with lighting control technologies such as LUXMATE EMOTION Interactive visualisation of light colour and coloured light, light quantity, direction of light (directional, diffuse) in room settings Project source data available from standard lighting design software such as DIALux and Relux Further information and downloads at: www.zumtobel.com/vivaldi

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 9 / 5

Online product information


Under the Download tab, the online catalogue provides a list of all product specifications available for a certain product. Quick access with URL/article reference: www.zumtobel.com/60710147

6 / Chapter 9

The Lighting Handbook

Product information available: Photometric data sheets inc. UGR tables and maintenance factors Data formats Eulumdat, IES CAD data: 2D and 3D Drag & drop data package for DIALux and Relux Brochures Installation instructions CE certificates

Product data sheets and installation instructions available online


Any product information required can be selected from the online catalogue and summarised in the form of a data sheet. Additionally, all installation instructions for the respective product are available in PDF format. Complete product information in PDF format, up to date and country-specific: figures, charts, images Compilation of the product information selected in the form of a data sheet (ZIP file) Photometric data sheets Data sheets with connecting instructions for LUXMATE products Quick dispatch of any part of the catalogue by e-mail

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 9 / 7

CAD data in 2D and 3D available online


The 2D and 3D data for ZUMTOBEL products can be downloaded free of charge in various formats, e.g. dxf, Rhino, Lightscape, 3D Studio Max etc. Quick selection of the required symbol 2D luminaire symbols for AutoCAD as library and in DXF format 3D luminaires for various CAD systems Special data sheets with connecting instructions for LUXMATE products Available formats: DXF, Rhino, Lightscape, 3D Studio Max Just take a look at: www.zumtobel.com/download

8 / Chapter 9

The Lighting Handbook

Online lighting design tools


QuickCalc online: QuickCalc provides for a quick, approximate determination of the number of luminaires required to achieve a defined illuminance level according to the light output ratio method or vice versa: to determine the illuminance level of a defined number of luminaires. In the ZUMTOBEL online catalogue, QuickCalc is available under the QuickCalc tab for products with calculation data.

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 9 / 9

FluxCalc online (calculation of luminous flux): Using FluxCalc, the luminous flux of T16 and T26 lamps in relation to ambient temperature can be determined. For T16 lamps, FluxCalc also includes the influence of ZUMTOBELs Cool Spot Optimizer in the calculation.

ZUMTOBEL Lighting DVD


ZUMTOBEL data plug-in for DIALux and Relux with all available product data (Product Explorer with QuickCalc and maintenance factor calculation), updated versions of DIALux and Relux as well as further tools: LUXMATE Energy Light, ZX2 configurator, ELI/LENI calculator and VIVALDI demo version.

10 / Chapter 9

The Lighting Handbook

Personal Notes

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 10

Personal Notes

Chapter 10

The Lighting Handbook

Personal Notes

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 10

Personal Notes

Chapter 10

The Lighting Handbook

Personal Notes

The Lighting Handbook

Chapter 10

United Kingdom Zumtobel Lighting Ltd. Unit 4 - The Argent Centre, Pump Lane London Hayes/Middlesex UB3 3BL T +44/(0)20 8589 1800 F +44/(0)20 8756 4800 M enquiriesuk@zumtobel.com www.zumtobel.co.uk

Hong Kong Zumtobel Lighting Hong Kong Unit 319, Level 43, Tower 1, Metroplaza, 223 Hing Fong Road, Kwai Chung, N.T. T +852/(0)2503 0466 F +852/(0)2503 0177 M admin@zumtobel.com.hk

United Arab Emirates Zumtobel Lighting GmbH USA and Canada Dubai Airport Free Zone, Zumtobel Lighting Inc. 3rd East Wing, 4th Floor, Location Highland Office 413 3300 Route 9W Highland, New York 1258-2630 PO Box 54620 Dubai T +1/(0)845/691 62 62 T +971/(4) 214 9845 F +1/(0)845/691 62 89 F +971/(4) 214 9501 www.zumtobel.us www.zumtobel.ca Norway Zumtobel Belysning Australia and New Zealand Pilestredet 75 C Zumtobel Lighting Pty Ltd 0354 Oslo 333 Pacific Highway Postbox 5829 Majorstuen North Sydney, NSW 2060 0308 Oslo T +61/(2)8913 5000 T +47/22 46 85 00 F +61/(2)8913 5001 F +47/22 46 85 02 M info@zumtobel.com.au M info.se@zumtobel.com www.zumtobel.com.au China Zumtobel Lighting China Beijing Office T5-2-152 Tayuan Diplomatic Compound No. 1 Xin Dong Road, Chaoyang District 100600 Beijing T +86/(10) 8532 3886 F +86/(10) 8532 3889 M admin@zumtobel.com.hk Sweden Zumtobel Belysning Birger Jarlsgatan 57 113 56 Stockholm T +46/(0)8/26 26 50 F +46/(0)8/26 56 05 M info.se@zumtobel.com www.zumtobel.se

Denmark Light Makers AS Indiavej 1 2100 Copenhagen T +45/(0)35 43 70 00 F +45/(0)35 43 54 54 M ralf.ritter@lightmakers.dk www.lightmakers.dk Czech Republic and Slovak Republic Zumtobel Lighting s.r.o. Vlastislavova 11 Praha 4 140 00 Praha T +420/(2) 41 740 301 F +420/(2) 41 740 308 M praha@zumtobel.com www.zumtobel.cz

Slovenia and Croatia Zumtobel Licht d.o.o. Dunajska cesta 159 1000 Ljubljana T +386/(1) 56 09 820 F +386/(1) 56 09 866 M bzslowenien@zumtobel.si www.zumtobel.si Headquarters Zumtobel Lighting GmbH Schweizer Strasse 30 Postfach 72 6851 Dornbirn, AUSTRIA T +43/(0)5572/390-0 F +43/(0)5572/22 826

Zumtobel Licht GmbH Grevenmarschstrasse 74-78 32657 Lemgo, GERMANY T +49/(0)5261/2 12-0 Poland Zumtobel Lighting GmbH Sp.z.o.o. F +49/(0)5261/2 12-7777 www.zumtobel.de Przedstawicielstwo w Polsce ul. Narbutta 46/48 www.zumtobel.com 02-541 Warszawa T +48/(22) 856 7431 F +48/(22) 856 7432 www.zumtobel.pl Russia Zumtobel Lighting GmbH Official Representative Office Skakovaya Str. 17 Bld. No 1, Office 1104 125040 Moscow T +7/(495) 945 36 33 F +7/(495) 945 16 94 www.zumtobel.ru

Art.-No. 04 797 525-UK 12/08 Zumtobel Lighting GmbH Technical data was correct at time of going to press. We reserve the right to make technical changes without notice. Please contact your local sales office for further information. Printed on environmentally-friendly chlorine-free paper.

You might also like